blob: ba8057fdfe2d8b6d371c889c68c79810ef659b3b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaueab1dc62013-06-17 15:10:25 +02007 2013/06/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
160everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
161established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
162sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
163while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
164another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
165sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
166http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
167mode.
168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
1701.2. HTTP request
171-----------------
172
173First, let's consider this HTTP request :
174
175 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100176 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
178 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
179 3 User-agent: my small browser
180 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
181 5 Accept: image/png
182
183
1841.2.1. The Request line
185-----------------------
186
187Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
188
189 - a METHOD : GET
190 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
191 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
192
193All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
194which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
195followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
196is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
197desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
198the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
199
200The URI itself can have several forms :
201
202 - A "relative URI" :
203
204 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
207 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
208
209 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
210
211 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
212
213 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
214 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
215 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
216 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
217 must accept this form too.
218
219 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
220 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
221 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
224 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
225 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
226 other protocols too.
227
228In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
229mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
230on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
231It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
232specific to the language, framework or application in use.
233
234
2351.2.2. The request headers
236--------------------------
237
238The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
239beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
240an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
241Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
242values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
243encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
244the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
245define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
246
247Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
248their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
249"Connection:" header).
250
251The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
252that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
253is one valid form of empty line.
254
255Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
256headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
257about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
258application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
259
260Important note:
261 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
262 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
263 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
264 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
265
266
2671.3. HTTP response
268------------------
269
270An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
271messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
272
273 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100274 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
276 2 Content-length: 350
277 3 Content-Type: text/html
278
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200279As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
280codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
281response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100282continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
283the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
284following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
285sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
286(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
287correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
288such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
289state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
290over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
291if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
292information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
2951.3.1. The Response line
296------------------------
297
298Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
299
300 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
301 - a status code : 200
302 - a reason : OK
303
304The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200305 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
307 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
308 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
309 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
310
311Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
314messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
315or "Authentication Required".
316
317Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
318
319 Code When / reason
320 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
321 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
322 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
323 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100324 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 400 for an invalid or too large request
327 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
328 accessing the stats page)
329 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
330 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
331 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
332 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
333 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
334 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
335 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
336 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
337 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
338
339The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3404.2).
341
342
3431.3.2. The response headers
344---------------------------
345
346Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
347the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
348details.
349
350
3512. Configuring HAProxy
352----------------------
353
3542.1. Configuration file format
355------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200356
357HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
358
359 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
360 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
361 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
362 "frontend" and "backend".
363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
365referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
366delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368escaped by doubling them.
369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
3712.2. Time format
372----------------
373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100374Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
376otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
377numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
378for every keyword. Supported units are :
379
380 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
381 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
382 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
383 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
384 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
385 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
386
387
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003882.3. Examples
389-------------
390
391 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
392 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
393 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
394 global
395 daemon
396 maxconn 256
397
398 defaults
399 mode http
400 timeout connect 5000ms
401 timeout client 50000ms
402 timeout server 50000ms
403
404 frontend http-in
405 bind *:80
406 default_backend servers
407
408 backend servers
409 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
410
411
412 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
413 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
414 global
415 daemon
416 maxconn 256
417
418 defaults
419 mode http
420 timeout connect 5000ms
421 timeout client 50000ms
422 timeout server 50000ms
423
424 listen http-in
425 bind *:80
426 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
427
428
429Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
430
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100431 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432
433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200435--------------------
436
437Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
438are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
439of them have command-line equivalents.
440
441The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
442
443 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200444 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - daemon
448 - gid
449 - group
450 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100451 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - nbproc
453 - pidfile
454 - uid
455 - ulimit-n
456 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200457 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200458 - node
459 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100460 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100461
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200462 * Performance tuning
463 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200464 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100465 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100466 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100467 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200468 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - noepoll
470 - nokqueue
471 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200473 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200474 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200475 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100476 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100477 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200478 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100479 - tune.maxaccept
480 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200481 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200482 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100483 - tune.rcvbuf.client
484 - tune.rcvbuf.server
485 - tune.sndbuf.client
486 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100487 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100488 - tune.ssl.lifetime
489 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100490 - tune.zlib.memlevel
491 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493 * Debugging
494 - debug
495 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200496
497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004983.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499------------------------------------
500
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200501ca-base <dir>
502 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200503 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
504 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506chroot <jail dir>
507 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
508 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
509 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
510 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
511 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
512 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100513
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100514cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
515 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
516 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
517 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
518 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
519 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
520 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
521 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
522 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
523 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
524 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
525 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
526 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
527 they overlap.
528
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200529crt-base <dir>
530 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
531 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
532 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
533
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200534daemon
535 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
536 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
537 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
538
539gid <number>
540 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
541 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
542 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100543 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
544 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547group <group name>
548 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
549 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100550
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200551log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
553 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100554 configured with "log global".
555
556 <address> can be one of:
557
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100558 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100559 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
560 port).
561
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100562 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
563 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
564 port).
565
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100566 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
567 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
568 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
569 writeable).
570
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100571 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
572 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
573 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
574 in Bourne shell.
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577
578 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
579 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
580 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
581
582 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200583 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
584 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
585 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
586 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
587 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
588 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200590 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100592log-send-hostname [<string>]
593 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
594 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
595 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
596 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
597 the logs.
598
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000599log-tag <string>
600 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
601 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
602 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
603 running on the same host.
604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605nbproc <number>
606 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
607 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
608 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
609 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
610 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
611
612pidfile <pidfile>
613 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
614 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
615 starting the process. See also "daemon".
616
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100617stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200618 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
619 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
620 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
621 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
622 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
623 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
624 the number of processes used.
625
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200626stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
627 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
628 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
629 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
630 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200631
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200632 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
633 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
634 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200635
636stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
637 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
638 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100639 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200640
641stats maxconn <connections>
642 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
643 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645uid <number>
646 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
647 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
648 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
649 one. See also "gid" and "user".
650
651ulimit-n <number>
652 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
653 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
654 option.
655
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100656unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
657 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
658
659 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
660 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
661 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
662 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
663 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
664 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
665 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
666 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
667 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
668 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670user <user name>
671 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
672 See also "uid" and "group".
673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200674node <name>
675 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
676
677 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
678 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
679 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
680 traffic.
681
682description <text>
683 Add a text that describes the instance.
684
685 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
686 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
687 "<" and ">" characters.
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006903.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691-----------------------
692
693maxconn <number>
694 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
695 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
696 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
697 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
698
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200699maxconnrate <number>
700 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
701 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
702 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
703 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
704 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
705 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
706 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
707 fairness.
708
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100709maxcomprate <number>
710 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
711 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
712 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
713 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
714 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
715 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
716 default value.
717
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100718maxcompcpuusage <number>
719 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
720 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
721 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
722 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
723 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
724 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
725 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
726 process down and from introducing high latencies.
727
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100728maxpipes <number>
729 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
730 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
731 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
732 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
733 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
734 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
735
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200736maxsslconn <number>
737 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
738 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
739 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
740 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
741 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
742 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
743 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
744
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100745maxzlibmem <number>
746 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
747 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
748 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100749 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
750 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
751 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
752
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753noepoll
754 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
755 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100756 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
758nokqueue
759 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
760 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
761 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
762
763nopoll
764 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
765 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100766 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100767 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100769nosplice
770 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
771 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
772 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100773 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100774 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
775 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
776 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
777 "option splice-response".
778
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200779spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
780 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
781 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
782 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
783 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
784 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
785
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200786tune.bufsize <number>
787 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
788 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
789 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
790 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
791 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
792 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
793 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
794 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400795 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
796 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
797 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200798
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200799tune.chksize <number>
800 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
801 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
802 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
803 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
804 checks whenever possible.
805
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100806tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
807 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
808 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
809 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
810 this value. The default value is 1.
811
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100812tune.http.cookielen <number>
813 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
814 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
815 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
816 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
817 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
818 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
819 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
820 to change this value.
821
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200822tune.http.maxhdr <number>
823 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
824 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
825 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
826 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
827 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
828 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
829 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
830 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
831 limit too high.
832
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100833tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100834 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
835 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
836 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
837 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
838 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
839 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
840 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
841 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
842 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
843 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100844
845tune.maxpollevents <number>
846 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
847 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
848 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
849 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
850 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
851
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200852tune.maxrewrite <number>
853 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
854 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
855 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
856 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
857 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
858 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
859 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
860 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
861 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
862 bufsize.
863
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200864tune.pipesize <number>
865 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
866 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
867 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
868 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
869 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
870 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
871
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100872tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
873tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
874 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
875 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
876 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
877 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
878 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
879 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
880 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
881
882tune.sndbuf.client <number>
883tune.sndbuf.server <number>
884 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
885 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
886 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
887 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
888 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
889 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
890 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
891 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
892 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
893 notifying haproxy again.
894
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100895tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100896 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
897 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
898 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
899 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
900 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
901 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
902 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
903 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
904 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100905 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
906 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100907
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100908tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
909 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
910 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
911 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
912 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
913 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
914 being used for too long.
915
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100916tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
917 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
918 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
919 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
920 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
921 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
922 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
923 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
924 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
925 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
926 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
927 best value.
928
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100929tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
930 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
931 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
932 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
933 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
934 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
935
936tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
937 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
938 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
939 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
940 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009423.3. Debugging
943--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200944
945debug
946 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
947 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
948 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
949 system startup.
950
951quiet
952 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
953 line argument "-q".
954
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009563.4. Userlists
957--------------
958It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
959http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
960it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
961
962userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100963 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100964 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
965
966group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100967 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100968 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
969 proceeded by "users" keyword.
970
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100971user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
972 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100973 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
974 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100975 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
976 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100977 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
978 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
979
980
981 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100982 userlist L1
983 group G1 users tiger,scott
984 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100985
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100986 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
987 user scott insecure-password elgato
988 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100989
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100990 userlist L2
991 group G1
992 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100993
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100994 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
995 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
996 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100997
998 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200999
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001000
10013.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001002----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001003It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1004haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1005pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1006identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1007or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1008Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1009known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1010the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1011process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1012during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1013tables.
1014
1015peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001016 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001017 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1018
1019peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1020 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1021 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1022 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1023 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1024 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1025 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1026
1027 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1028 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1029
1030 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1031 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1032 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1033 across all peers.
1034
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001035 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1036 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1037 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1038
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001039 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001040 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001041 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1042 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1043 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001044
1045 backend mybackend
1046 mode tcp
1047 balance roundrobin
1048 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1049 stick on src
1050
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001051 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1052 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001053
1054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010554. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001057
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001058Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1059 - defaults <name>
1060 - frontend <name>
1061 - backend <name>
1062 - listen <name>
1063
1064A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1065its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1066section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001067section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
1069A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1070connections.
1071
1072A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1073to forward incoming connections.
1074
1075A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1076parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001078All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1079'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1080case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1081
1082Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1083logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1084proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1085However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1086name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1087
1088Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1089and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001090bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001091protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1092modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1093arbitrary criteria.
1094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010964.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1097--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001099The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1100limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1101they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1102limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001103marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001104option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001105and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1106with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1107specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001108
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001110 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1111------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1112acl - X X X
1113appsession - - X X
1114backlog X X X -
1115balance X - X X
1116bind - X X -
1117bind-process X X X X
1118block - X X X
1119capture cookie - X X -
1120capture request header - X X -
1121capture response header - X X -
1122clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001123compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001124contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1125cookie X - X X
1126default-server X - X X
1127default_backend X X X -
1128description - X X X
1129disabled X X X X
1130dispatch - - X X
1131enabled X X X X
1132errorfile X X X X
1133errorloc X X X X
1134errorloc302 X X X X
1135-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1136errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001137force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001138fullconn X - X X
1139grace X X X X
1140hash-type X - X X
1141http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001142http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001143http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001144http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001145http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001146http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001147id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001148ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001149log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001150maxconn X X X -
1151mode X X X X
1152monitor fail - X X -
1153monitor-net X X X -
1154monitor-uri X X X -
1155option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1156option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1157option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1158option allbackups (*) X - X X
1159option checkcache (*) X - X X
1160option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1161option contstats (*) X X X -
1162option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1163option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1164option forceclose (*) X X X X
1165-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1166option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001167option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001168option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001169option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1170option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1171option httpchk X - X X
1172option httpclose (*) X X X X
1173option httplog X X X X
1174option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001175option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09001176option lb-agent-chk X - X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001177option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001178option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1179option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1180option logasap (*) X X X -
1181option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001182option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001183option nolinger (*) X X X X
1184option originalto X X X X
1185option persist (*) X - X X
1186option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001187option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001188option smtpchk X - X X
1189option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1190option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1191option splice-request (*) X X X X
1192option splice-response (*) X X X X
1193option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1194option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1195-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1196option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1197option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1198option tcpka X X X X
1199option tcplog X X X X
1200option transparent (*) X - X X
1201persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1202rate-limit sessions X X X -
1203redirect - X X X
1204redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1205redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1206reqadd - X X X
1207reqallow - X X X
1208reqdel - X X X
1209reqdeny - X X X
1210reqiallow - X X X
1211reqidel - X X X
1212reqideny - X X X
1213reqipass - X X X
1214reqirep - X X X
1215reqisetbe - X X X
1216reqitarpit - X X X
1217reqpass - X X X
1218reqrep - X X X
1219-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1220reqsetbe - X X X
1221reqtarpit - X X X
1222retries X - X X
1223rspadd - X X X
1224rspdel - X X X
1225rspdeny - X X X
1226rspidel - X X X
1227rspideny - X X X
1228rspirep - X X X
1229rsprep - X X X
1230server - - X X
1231source X - X X
1232srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001233stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001234stats auth X - X X
1235stats enable X - X X
1236stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001237stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001238stats realm X - X X
1239stats refresh X - X X
1240stats scope X - X X
1241stats show-desc X - X X
1242stats show-legends X - X X
1243stats show-node X - X X
1244stats uri X - X X
1245-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1246stick match - - X X
1247stick on - - X X
1248stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001249stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001250stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001251tcp-request connection - X X -
1252tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001253tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001254tcp-response content - - X X
1255tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001256timeout check X - X X
1257timeout client X X X -
1258timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1259timeout connect X - X X
1260timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1261timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1262timeout http-request X X X X
1263timeout queue X - X X
1264timeout server X - X X
1265timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1266timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001267timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001268transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001269unique-id-format X X X -
1270unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001271use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001272use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001273------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1274 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012774.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1278---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001279
1280This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1281
1282
1283acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1284 Declare or complete an access list.
1285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1286 no | yes | yes | yes
1287 Example:
1288 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1289 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1290 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001292 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001293
1294
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001295appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1296 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001297 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1299 no | no | yes | yes
1300 Arguments :
1301 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1302 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1303
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001304 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001305 checked in each cookie value.
1306
1307 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1308 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1309 milliseconds.
1310
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001311 request-learn
1312 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1313 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1314 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1315 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1316 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1317 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1318
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001319 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1320 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1321 data following this prefix.
1322
1323 Example :
1324 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1325
1326 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1327 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1328
1329 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1330 2 modes are currently supported :
1331 - path-parameters :
1332 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1333 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1334 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1335 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1336 - query-string :
1337 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1338 query string.
1339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001340 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1341 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1342 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1343 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001344 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1345 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1346 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001347 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1348 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1349
1350 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1351
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001352 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1353 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1354 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001356 Example :
1357 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1358
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001359 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1360 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001361
1362
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001363backlog <conns>
1364 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1366 yes | yes | yes | no
1367 Arguments :
1368 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1369 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001370 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001371
1372 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1373 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1374 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1375 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1376 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1377 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1378 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1379 backlog parameter.
1380
1381 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1382 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1383 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1384
1385 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1386
1387
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001388balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001389balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001390 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1392 yes | no | yes | yes
1393 Arguments :
1394 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1395 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1396 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1397 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1398
1399 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1400 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1401 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1402 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001403 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001404 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001405 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1406 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1407 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1408 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1409 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1410 it, so that you don't worry.
1411
1412 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1413 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1414 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1415 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1416 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1417 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1418 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1419 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001420
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001421 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1422 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1423 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1424 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1425 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1426 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1427 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1428 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1429
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001430 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1431 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1432 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1433 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001434 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001435 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1436 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1437 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1438 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1439 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001440 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1441 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1442 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1443 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1444 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1445 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001447 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1448 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1449 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1450 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1451 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1452 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1453 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1454 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001455 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001456 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001457 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1458 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1459 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001460
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001461 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1462 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1463 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1464 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1465 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1466 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1467 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1468 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1469 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1470 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1471 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1472 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001473
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001474 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001475 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1476 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1477 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1478 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1479 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1480 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1481 URIs start with a leading "/".
1482
1483 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1484 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1485 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1486 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1487
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001488 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001489 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1490
1491 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001492 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1493 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1494 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1495 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1496 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1497 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1498 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1499 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1500 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1501 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1502 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1503 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1504 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1505 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1506 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1507 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1508 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1509 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1510 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001511
1512 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1513 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1514 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1515 server will receive the request.
1516
1517 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1518 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1519 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1520 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1521 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001522 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1523 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1524 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001525
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001526 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1527 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1528 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1529 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1530 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001531
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001532 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001533 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1534 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1535 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1536
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001537 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1538 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1539 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1540
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001541 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001542 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001543 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1544 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1545 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1546 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1547 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1548 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001549 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001550 used instead.
1551
1552 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1553 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1554 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1555 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1556
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001557 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1558 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1559 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1560
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001561 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001562
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001563 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001564 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1565 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001566
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001567 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001568 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001569
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001570 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1571 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1572 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001573
1574 Examples :
1575 balance roundrobin
1576 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001577 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001578 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1579 balance hdr(host)
1580 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001581
1582 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1583 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1584
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001585 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001586 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1587 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1588 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1589 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1590
1591 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1592 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1593 defaults to 16 kB.
1594
1595 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1596 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1597
1598 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1599 Round Robin.
1600
1601 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1602 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1603 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1604 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1605
1606 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1607
1608 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001609 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001610 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1611 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1612 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001613
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001614 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1615 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001616
1617
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001618bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1619bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001620 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1622 no | yes | yes | no
1623 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001624 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1625 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1626 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1627 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001628 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001629 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1630 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1631 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1632 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1633 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1634 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1635 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001636 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1637 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1638 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001639 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1640 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1641 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1642 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001643
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001644 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1645 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001646 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1647 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1648 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001649 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1650 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1651 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1652 the range.
1653
1654 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1655 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1656 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1657 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1658 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1659 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1660 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001661 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001662 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001663
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001664 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1665 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1666 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1667 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1668 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1669 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1670 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1671 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1672
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001673 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1674 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1675 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1676 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001678 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1679 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1680 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1681 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1682 in a frontend.
1683
1684 Example :
1685 listen http_proxy
1686 bind :80,:443
1687 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001688 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001689
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001690 listen http_https_proxy
1691 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001692 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001693
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001694 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1695 bind ipv6@:80
1696 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1697 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1698
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001699 listen external_bind_app1
1700 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1701
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001702 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001703 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704
1705
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001706bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001707 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1709 yes | yes | yes | yes
1710 Arguments :
1711 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1712 may be used to override a default value.
1713
1714 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1715 option may be combined with other numbers.
1716
1717 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1718 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1719 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1720 missing from all processes.
1721
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001722 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1723 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1724 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1725 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1726 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001727
1728 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1729 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1730 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1731 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1732 and 'even' instances.
1733
1734 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1735 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1736 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1737 32.
1738
1739 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1740 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1741
1742 Example :
1743 listen app_ip1
1744 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001745 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001746
1747 listen app_ip2
1748 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001749 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001750
1751 listen management
1752 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001753 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001754
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001755 listen management
1756 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1757 bind-process 1-4
1758
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001759 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1760
1761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762block { if | unless } <condition>
1763 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1765 no | yes | yes | yes
1766
1767 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1768 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001769 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001770 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1772 "block" statements per instance.
1773
1774 Example:
1775 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1776 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1777 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1778 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001780 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781
1782
1783capture cookie <name> len <length>
1784 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1786 no | yes | yes | no
1787 Arguments :
1788 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1789 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1790 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1791 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1792 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1793
1794 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1795 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1796 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1797 right if it exceeds <length>.
1798
1799 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1800 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1801 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1802 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1803
1804 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1805 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1806 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1807
1808 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1809 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1810 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001811 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1812 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1813 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001814
1815 Example:
1816 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1817
1818 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001819 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001820
1821
1822capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001823 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1825 no | yes | yes | no
1826 Arguments :
1827 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001828 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001829 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1830 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1831 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1832
1833 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1834 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1835 it exceeds <length>.
1836
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001837 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001838 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1839 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001840 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1841 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1842 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1843 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001844 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001845 environments to find where the request came from.
1846
1847 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1848 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1849 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1850 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001851
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001852 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1853 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1854 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1855 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1856 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857
1858 Example:
1859 capture request header Host len 15
1860 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1861 capture request header Referrer len 15
1862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001863 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001864 about logging.
1865
1866
1867capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001868 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1870 no | yes | yes | no
1871 Arguments :
1872 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001873 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001874 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1875 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1876 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1877
1878 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1879 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1880 it exceeds <length>.
1881
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001882 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1884 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1885 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001886 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1887 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1888 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1889 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001890
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001891 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1892 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1893 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1894 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1895 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001896
1897 Example:
1898 capture response header Content-length len 9
1899 capture response header Location len 15
1900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001901 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001902 about logging.
1903
1904
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001905clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1908 yes | yes | yes | no
1909 Arguments :
1910 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1911 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1912 as explained at the top of this document.
1913
1914 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1915 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1916 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1917 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1918 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1919 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1920 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1921 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001922 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001923 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1924 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1925
1926 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1927 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1928 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1929 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1930 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1931 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1932
1933 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1934 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1935
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001936 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1937 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001938
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001939compression algo <algorithm> ...
1940compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001941compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001942 Enable HTTP compression.
1943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1944 yes | yes | yes | yes
1945 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001946 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1947 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1948 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1949
1950 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001951 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001952 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1953 data.
1954
1955 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1956 support for zlib was built in.
1957
1958 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1959 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1960 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1961 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1962 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1963 in.
1964
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001965 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001966 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001967 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1968 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1969 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1970 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1971 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001972
1973 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1974 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1975 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1976 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1977 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001978 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1979 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1980 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1981 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1982 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1983 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001984
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001985 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001986 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
1987 "Accept-Encoding" header
1988 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001989 * HTTP status code is not 200
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001990 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
1991 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
1992 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
1993 "multipart"
1994 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
1995 header
1996 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
1997 and later
1998 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
1999 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002000
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002001 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2002 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002003
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002004 Examples :
2005 compression algo gzip
2006 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002008contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002009 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2011 yes | no | yes | yes
2012 Arguments :
2013 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2014 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2015 as explained at the top of this document.
2016
2017 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002018 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002019 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2021 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2022 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2023 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2024
2025 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2026 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2027 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2028 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2029 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2030 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2031
2032 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2033 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2034 instead.
2035
2036 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2037 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2038
2039
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002040cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002041 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2042 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2045 yes | no | yes | yes
2046 Arguments :
2047 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2048 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2049 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2050 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2051 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2052 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2053 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2054 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2055 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2056
2057 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2058 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2059 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2060 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2061 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2062 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2063 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2064 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2065 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2066 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2067 "insert" and "prefix".
2068
2069 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002070 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002071
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002072 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002073 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2074 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2075 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2076 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2077 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2078 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2079 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2080 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2081 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2082 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083
2084 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2085 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2086 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2087 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2088 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2089 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2090 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2091 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2092 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2093 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002094 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2095 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2096 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002097
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002098 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2099 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2100 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002101 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2102 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2103 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2104 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002105 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2106 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2107 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002108
2109 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2110 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2111 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2112 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2113 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2114 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2115 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2116 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2117 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2118
2119 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2120 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2121 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2122 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2123 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2124 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2125 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2126 persistence cookie in the cache.
2127 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2128
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002129 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2130 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2131 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2132 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2133 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2134 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2135 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2136 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2137 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2138 they logout.
2139
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002140 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2141 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2142 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2143 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2144
2145 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2146 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2147 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2148 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2149 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2150 this attribute.
2151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002152 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002153 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002154 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2155 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2156 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2157 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2158 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2159 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002160
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002161 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2162 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2163 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2164 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2165 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2166 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2167 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2168 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2169 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2170 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2171 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2172 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2173 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2174 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2175 the site.
2176
2177 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2178 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2179 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2180 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2181 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2182 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2183 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2184 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2185 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2186 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2187 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2188 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2189 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2190 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2191 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2192 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2193
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002194 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2195 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2196 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2197 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002198
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002199 Examples :
2200 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2201 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2202 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002203 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002204
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002205 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002206 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002207
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002208
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002209default-server [param*]
2210 Change default options for a server in a backend
2211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2212 yes | no | yes | yes
2213 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002214 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2215 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2216 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2217 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002218
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002219 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002220 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2221
2222 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002223
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002224
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002225default_backend <backend>
2226 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2228 yes | yes | yes | no
2229 Arguments :
2230 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2231
2232 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2233 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2234 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2235 will catch all undetermined requests.
2236
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002237 Example :
2238
2239 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2240 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2241 default_backend dynamic
2242
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002243 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2244
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002246description <string>
2247 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2249 no | yes | yes | yes
2250 Arguments : string
2251
2252 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2253 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2254 it describes.
2255 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2256
2257
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002258disabled
2259 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2261 yes | yes | yes | yes
2262 Arguments : none
2263
2264 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2265 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2266 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2267 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2268 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2269 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2270 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2271
2272 See also : "enabled"
2273
2274
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002275dispatch <address>:<port>
2276 Set a default server address
2277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2278 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002279 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002280
2281 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2282 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2283 during start-up.
2284
2285 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2286 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2287 possible with normal servers.
2288
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002289 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002290 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2291 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2292 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2293 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2294
2295 See also : "server"
2296
2297
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002298enabled
2299 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2301 yes | yes | yes | yes
2302 Arguments : none
2303
2304 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2305 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2306
2307 See also : "disabled"
2308
2309
2310errorfile <code> <file>
2311 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2313 yes | yes | yes | yes
2314 Arguments :
2315 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002316 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002317
2318 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002319 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002320 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002321 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2322 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002323
2324 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2325 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2326 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2327
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002328 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2329
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002330 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2331 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2332 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2333 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2334
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002335 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2336 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2337 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2338 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2339 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2340 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2343 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2344 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002345 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002346 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2347
2348 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2349
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002350 Example :
2351 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2352 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2353 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2354
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002355
2356errorloc <code> <url>
2357errorloc302 <code> <url>
2358 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2360 yes | yes | yes | yes
2361 Arguments :
2362 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002363 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002364
2365 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2366 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2367 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2368 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2369 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2370
2371 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2372 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2373 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2374
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002375 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2376
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002377 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2378 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2379 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2380 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2381 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2382 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2383 request.
2384
2385 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2386
2387
2388errorloc303 <code> <url>
2389 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2391 yes | yes | yes | yes
2392 Arguments :
2393 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2394 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2395
2396 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2397 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2398 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2399 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2400 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2401
2402 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2403 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2404 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2405
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002406 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2407
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002408 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2409 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2410 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2411 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002412 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002413
2414 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2415
2416
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002417force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2418 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2419 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2420 no | yes | yes | yes
2421
2422 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2423 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2424 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2425 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2426 marked down for maintenance operations.
2427
2428 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2429 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2430 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2431 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2432 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2433 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2434 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2435 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2436 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2437
2438 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2439 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2440 is used.
2441
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002442 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002443 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002444
2445
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002446fullconn <conns>
2447 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2449 yes | no | yes | yes
2450 Arguments :
2451 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2452 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2453
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002454 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002455 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002456 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002457 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2458 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2459 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2460 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2461 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002462 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002463
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002464 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2465 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2466 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2467
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002468 Example :
2469 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2470 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2471 # connections.
2472 backend dynamic
2473 fullconn 10000
2474 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2475 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2476
2477 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2478
2479
2480grace <time>
2481 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002483 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002484 Arguments :
2485 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2486 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2487 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2488
2489 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2490 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002491 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002492 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2493
2494 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2495 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2496 simplify it.
2497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002498
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002499hash-type <method>
2500 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2502 yes | no | yes | yes
2503 Arguments :
2504 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2505 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2506 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2507 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2508 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2509 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2510 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2511 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2512 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2513
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002514 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2515 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2516 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2517 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2518 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2519 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2520 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2521 this value.
2522
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002523 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2524 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2525 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2526 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2527 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2528 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2529 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2530 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2531 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2532 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2533 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2534 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2535 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2536
2537 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2538
2539 See also : "balance", "server"
2540
2541
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002542http-check disable-on-404
2543 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002545 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002546 Arguments : none
2547
2548 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2549 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2550 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2551 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2552 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2553 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2554 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2555 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002556 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2557 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2558 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2559
2560 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2561
2562
2563http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002564 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002566 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002567 Arguments :
2568 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2569 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002570 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002571 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2572 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2573 details on the supported keywords.
2574
2575 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2576 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2577 with the usual backslash ('\').
2578
2579 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2580 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2581 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2582 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2583 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2584
2585 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002586 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002587 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2588 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2589 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2590
2591 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002592 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002593 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2594 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2595 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2596 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2597
2598 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002599 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002600 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2601 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2602 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2603 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2604 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2605 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2606 trace).
2607
2608 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002609 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002610 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2611 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2612 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2613 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2614 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2615 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2616
2617 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2618 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2619 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2620 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2621 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2622 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2623 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2624 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2625
2626 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2627 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2628
2629 Examples :
2630 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002631 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002632
2633 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002634 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002635
2636 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002637 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002638
2639 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002640 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002641
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002642 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002643
2644
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002645http-check send-state
2646 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2648 yes | no | yes | yes
2649 Arguments : none
2650
2651 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2652 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2653 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2654 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2655 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2656
2657 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2658 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2659 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2660 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2661 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2662 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2663 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2664 checked in multiple backends.
2665
2666 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2667 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2668
2669 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2670 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2671 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2672 one fails.
2673
2674 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2675 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2676 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2677
2678 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2679 server's queue.
2680
2681 Example of a header received by the application server :
2682 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2683 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2684
2685 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2686
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002687http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002688 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002689 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2690 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002691 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002692 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2693
2694 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2695 no | yes | yes | yes
2696
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002697 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2698 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2699 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2700 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2701 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002702
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002703 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2704 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2705 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2706
2707 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2708 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2709 are evaluated.
2710
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002711 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2712 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2713 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2714 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2715 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2716 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2717 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2718 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2719 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2720 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2721 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2722
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002723 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2724 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2725 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2726 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2727 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2728
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002729 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2730 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2731 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
2732 "http-request" rules. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
2733
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002734 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2735 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2736 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2737 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2738 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2739 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2740 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2741 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2742
2743 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2744 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2745 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2746 external users.
2747
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002748 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2749 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2750 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2751 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2752 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2753 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2754 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2755 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2756
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002757 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2758 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2759 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2760 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2761 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2762 another equipment.
2763
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002764 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2765 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2766 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2767 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2768 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2769 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2770 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2771 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2772
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002773 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2774 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2775 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2776 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2777 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2778 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2779 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2780 admin privileges.
2781
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002782 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2783
2784 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2785 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2786 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2787 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002788
2789 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002790 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2791 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2792 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002793
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002794 http-request allow if nagios
2795 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2796 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2797 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002798
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002799 Example:
2800 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002801 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002802
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002803 Example:
2804 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2805 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2806 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2807 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2808 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2809 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2810 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2811 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2812 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2813
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002814 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2815 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002816
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002817http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002818 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002819 set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
2820 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002821 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2822
2823 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2824 no | yes | yes | yes
2825
2826 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2827 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2828 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2829 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2830 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2831 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2832
2833 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2834 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2835 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2836 current section.
2837
2838 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2839 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2840 rules are evaluated.
2841
2842 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2843 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2844 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2845 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2846 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2847 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
2848 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
2849
2850 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2851 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2852 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2853 external users.
2854
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002855 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2856 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2857 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2858 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2859 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2860 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2861 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2862 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2863
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002864 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2865 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2866 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2867 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2868 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2869 another equipment.
2870
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002871 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2872 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2873 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2874 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2875 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2876 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2877 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2878 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2879
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002880 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2881 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2882 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2883 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2884 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2885 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2886 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2887 admin privileges.
2888
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002889 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
2890
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08002891 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002892 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
2893 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
2894 rules.
2895
2896 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
2897 ACL usage.
2898
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002899http-send-name-header [<header>]
2900 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2901
2902 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2903 yes | no | yes | yes
2904
2905 Arguments :
2906
2907 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2908
2909 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2910 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2911 is added with the header string proved.
2912
2913 See also : "server"
2914
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002915id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002916 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2918 no | yes | yes | yes
2919 Arguments : none
2920
2921 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2922 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2923 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002924
2925
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002926ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2927 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2928 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2929 no | yes | yes | yes
2930
2931 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2932 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2933 and running).
2934
2935 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2936 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2937 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2938 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2939 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2940
2941 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2942 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2943
2944 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2945 "unless" condition is met.
2946
2947 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2948
2949
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002950log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002951log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002952no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002953 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2955 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002956
2957 Prefix :
2958 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2959 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2960 prefix does not allow arguments.
2961
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002962 Arguments :
2963 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2964 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2965 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2966 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2967 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2968 parameter.
2969
2970 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2971 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2972
2973 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2974 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2975 standard syslog port).
2976
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002977 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2978 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2979 standard syslog port).
2980
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002981 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2982 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2983 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2984 appropriately writeable).
2985
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002986 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
2987 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
2988 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
2989 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
2990
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002991 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2992
2993 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2994 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2995 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2996
2997 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2998 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2999 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003000 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3001 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3002 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3003 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3004 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003005
3006 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3007
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003008 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3009 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3010 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003011
3012 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3013 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3014 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3015 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3016
3017 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3018 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003019
3020 Example :
3021 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003022 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3023 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003024 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3025
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003026
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003027log-format <string>
3028 Allows you to custom a log line.
3029
3030 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3031
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003032
3033maxconn <conns>
3034 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3036 yes | yes | yes | no
3037 Arguments :
3038 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3039 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3040 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3041 closes.
3042
3043 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3044 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3045 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3046 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3047 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3048 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3049 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3050 properly tuned.
3051
3052 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3053 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3054 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3055
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003056 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3057
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003058 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3059
3060
3061mode { tcp|http|health }
3062 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3064 yes | yes | yes | yes
3065 Arguments :
3066 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3067 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3068 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3069 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3070
3071 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3072 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3073 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3074 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3075 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3076
3077 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003078 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3079 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3080 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3081 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3082 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3083 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3084 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003085
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003086 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3087 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3088 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003089
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003090 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003091 defaults http_instances
3092 mode http
3093
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003094 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003095
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003096
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003097monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003098 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3100 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003101 Arguments :
3102 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3103 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003104 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3106 backend and its backup.
3107
3108 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3109 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3110 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3111 servers in a list of backends.
3112
3113 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3114 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3115 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3116 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3117 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3118 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3119 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003120 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3121 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003122
3123 Example:
3124 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003125 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003126 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3127 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3128 monitor-uri /site_alive
3129 monitor fail if site_dead
3130
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003131 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003132
3133
3134monitor-net <source>
3135 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3137 yes | yes | yes | no
3138 Arguments :
3139 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3140 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3141 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3142 followed by a mask.
3143
3144 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3145 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003146 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003147 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3148
3149 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3150 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3151 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3152 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003153 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3154 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3155 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003156
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003157 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3158 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3159 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3160 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3161 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3162 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003163
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003164 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3165 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003166
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003167 Example :
3168 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3169 frontend www
3170 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3171
3172 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3173
3174
3175monitor-uri <uri>
3176 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3178 yes | yes | yes | no
3179 Arguments :
3180 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3181 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3182
3183 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3184 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3185 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3186 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3187 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3188 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3189 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3190 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3191
3192 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3193 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3194 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3195 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3196 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3197 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3198
3199 Example :
3200 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3201 frontend www
3202 mode http
3203 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3204
3205 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3206
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003207
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003208option abortonclose
3209no option abortonclose
3210 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3212 yes | no | yes | yes
3213 Arguments : none
3214
3215 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3216 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3217 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3218 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003219 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003220 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3221 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3222 encountered while delivering the response.
3223
3224 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3225 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3226 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3227 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3228 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3229 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003230 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003231 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003232 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003233 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3234 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3235 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3236
3237 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3238 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3239 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3240 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3241 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3242 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3243 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3244 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003245 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003246
3247 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3248 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3249
3250 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3251
3252
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003253option accept-invalid-http-request
3254no option accept-invalid-http-request
3255 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3257 yes | yes | yes | no
3258 Arguments : none
3259
3260 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3261 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3262 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3263 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3264 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3265 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3266 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3267 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003268 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3269 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3270 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3271 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3272 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3273 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003274
3275 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3276 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3277 been confirmed.
3278
3279 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3280 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003281 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3282 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003283 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3284
3285 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3286 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3287
3288 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3289 stats socket.
3290
3291
3292option accept-invalid-http-response
3293no option accept-invalid-http-response
3294 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3296 yes | no | yes | yes
3297 Arguments : none
3298
3299 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3300 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3301 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3302 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3303 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3304 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3305 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3306 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3307 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3308
3309 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3310 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3311 been confirmed.
3312
3313 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3314 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3315 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3316 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3317
3318 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3319 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3320
3321 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3322 stats socket.
3323
3324
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003325option allbackups
3326no option allbackups
3327 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3329 yes | no | yes | yes
3330 Arguments : none
3331
3332 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3333 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3334 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3335 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3336 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3337 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3338 order between the backup servers anymore.
3339
3340 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3341 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3342
3343 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3344 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3345
3346
3347option checkcache
3348no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003349 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3351 yes | no | yes | yes
3352 Arguments : none
3353
3354 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3355 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003356 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003357 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3358 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003359 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003360
3361 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003362 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003363 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003364 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3365 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003366 to the client are :
3367 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003368 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003369 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003370 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3371 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3372 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3373 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3374 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3375 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3376 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3377 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3378 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3379 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3380 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3381
3382 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003383 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003384 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003385 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003386 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3387
3388 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3389 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003390 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003391 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3392
3393 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3394 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3395
3396
3397option clitcpka
3398no option clitcpka
3399 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3401 yes | yes | yes | no
3402 Arguments : none
3403
3404 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3405 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3406 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3407 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3408
3409 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3410 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3411 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3412 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3413
3414 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3415 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3416 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3417 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3418 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3419
3420 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3421
3422 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3423 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3424 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3425
3426 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3427 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3428
3429 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3430
3431
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003432option contstats
3433 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3435 yes | yes | yes | no
3436 Arguments : none
3437
3438 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3439 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3440 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3441 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3442 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3443 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3444 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3445
3446
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003447option dontlog-normal
3448no option dontlog-normal
3449 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3451 yes | yes | yes | no
3452 Arguments : none
3453
3454 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3455 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3456 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3457 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3458 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3459 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3460 logged.
3461
3462 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3463 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3464 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3465
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003466 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003467 logging.
3468
3469
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003470option dontlognull
3471no option dontlognull
3472 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3474 yes | yes | yes | no
3475 Arguments : none
3476
3477 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3478 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3479 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3480 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3481 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3482 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3483 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3484
3485 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3486 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3487 would not be logged.
3488
3489 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3490 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003492 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003493
3494
3495option forceclose
3496no option forceclose
3497 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003499 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003500 Arguments : none
3501
3502 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3503 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3504 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3505 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3506 global session times in the logs.
3507
3508 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003509 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003510 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3511 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3512 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3513 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003514
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003515 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3516 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3517 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3518
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003519 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3520 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3521
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003522 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003523
3524
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003525option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003526 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3528 yes | yes | yes | yes
3529 Arguments :
3530 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3531 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003532 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003533 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003534
3535 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3536 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3537 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3538 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3539 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3540 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3541 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003542 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3543 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3544 possible that the client has already brought one.
3545
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003546 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003547 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003548 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3549 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003550 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3551 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003552
3553 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3554 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3555 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3556 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3557 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3558 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3559 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3560
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003561 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3562 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3563 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3564 are under the control of the end-user.
3565
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003566 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003567 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3568 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003569 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3570 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3571 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003572
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003573 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3574 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3575 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3576 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3577 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003578
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003579 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003580 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3581 frontend www
3582 mode http
3583 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3584
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003585 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3586 backend www
3587 mode http
3588 option forwardfor header X-Client
3589
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003590 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3591 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003592
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003593
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003594option http-no-delay
3595no option http-no-delay
3596 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3598 yes | yes | yes | yes
3599 Arguments : none
3600
3601 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3602 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3603 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3604 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3605 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3606 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3607 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3608 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3609 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3610 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3611 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3612 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3613 affected.
3614
3615 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3616 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3617 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3618 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3619 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3620 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3621 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3622 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3623 latency environments.
3624
3625
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003626option http-pretend-keepalive
3627no option http-pretend-keepalive
3628 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3630 yes | yes | yes | yes
3631 Arguments : none
3632
3633 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3634 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3635 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3636 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3637 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3638 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3639 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3640 consider the response complete.
3641
3642 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3643 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3644 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3645 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3646 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3647 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3648
3649 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3650 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3651 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3652 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3653 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3654 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3655 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3656
3657 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3658 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003659 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003660 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3661 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003662
3663 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3664 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3665
3666 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3667
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003668
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003669option http-server-close
3670no option http-server-close
3671 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3673 yes | yes | yes | yes
3674 Arguments : none
3675
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003676 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3677 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3678 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3679 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3680 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3681 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3682 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3683 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3684 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3685 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3686 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3687 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003688
3689 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3690 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3691 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3692 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003693 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3694 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003695
3696 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3697 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003698 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3699 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3700 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003701
3702 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3703 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3704
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003705 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3706 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003707
3708
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003709option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003710no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003711 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3713 yes | yes | yes | no
3714 Arguments : none
3715
3716 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3717 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3718 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3719 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3720 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3721 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3722 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3723
3724 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3725 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3726 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3727 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3728 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3729 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3730 request along its whole life.
3731
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003732 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3733 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3734 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3735 front of an existing proxy.
3736
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003737 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3738
3739 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3740 http-server-close".
3741
3742
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003743option httpchk
3744option httpchk <uri>
3745option httpchk <method> <uri>
3746option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3747 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 yes | no | yes | yes
3750 Arguments :
3751 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3752 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3753 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3754 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3755 ones.
3756
3757 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3758 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3759 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3760
3761 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3762 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3763 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3764 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3765 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3766
3767 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3768 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3769 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3770 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3771 the lack of any response.
3772
3773 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3774
3775 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3776 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3777 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3778
3779 Examples :
3780 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3781 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3782 backend https_relay
3783 mode tcp
3784 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3785 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3786
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003787 See also : "option lb-agent-chk", "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk",
3788 "option mysql-check", "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and
3789 the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003790
3791
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003792option httpclose
3793no option httpclose
3794 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3796 yes | yes | yes | yes
3797 Arguments : none
3798
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003799 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3800 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3801 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3802 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3803 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3804 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3805 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003806
3807 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003808 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003809 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3810 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3811 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3812 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3813 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003814
3815 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3816 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3817 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003818 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3819 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003820
3821 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3822 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3823
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003824 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3825 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003826
3827
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003828option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003829 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3831 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003832 Arguments :
3833 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3834 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3835 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3836 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3837 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003838
3839 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3840 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3841 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3842 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3843 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3844 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3845 ports.
3846
3847 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3848
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003849 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3850 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3851 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3852 by default.
3853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003854 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003855
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003856
3857option http_proxy
3858no option http_proxy
3859 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3861 yes | yes | yes | yes
3862 Arguments : none
3863
3864 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3865 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3866 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3867 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3868 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3869
3870 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3871 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3872 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3873 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003874 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003875 be analyzed.
3876
3877 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3878 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3879
3880 Example :
3881 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3882 backend direct_forward
3883 option httpclose
3884 option http_proxy
3885
3886 See also : "option httpclose"
3887
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003888
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003889option independent-streams
3890no option independent-streams
3891 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3893 yes | yes | yes | yes
3894 Arguments : none
3895
3896 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3897 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3898 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3899 receive data or not.
3900
3901 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3902 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3903 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3904 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3905 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3906 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3907 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3908 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3909 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3910 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3911 socket buffers.
3912
3913 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3914 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3915 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3916 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3917 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3918
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003919 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3920 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3921 deprecated.
3922
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003923 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003924
3925
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003926option lb-agent-chk
3927 Use a TCP connection to obtain a metric of server health
3928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3929 yes | no | yes | yes
3930 Arguments : none
3931
3932 This alters health checking behaviour by connecting making a TCP
3933 connection and reading an ASCII string. The string should have one of
3934 the following forms:
3935
3936 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
3937 e.g. "75%"
3938
3939 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
3940 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
3941
3942 * The string "drain".
3943
3944 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
3945 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
3946 persistence.
3947
3948 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
3949
3950 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
3951
3952 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
3953
3954 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3955
3956 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
3957
3958 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3959
3960 The use of an alternate check-port, used to obtain agent heath check
3961 information described above as opposed to the port of the service, may be
3962 useful in conjunction with this option.
3963
3964
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003965option ldap-check
3966 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3968 yes | no | yes | yes
3969 Arguments : none
3970
3971 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3972 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3973 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3974 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3975
3976 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3977 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3978
3979 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3980 configure it.
3981
3982 Example :
3983 option ldap-check
3984
3985 See also : "option httpchk"
3986
3987
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003988option log-health-checks
3989no option log-health-checks
3990 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3992 yes | no | yes | yes
3993 Arguments : none
3994
3995 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3996 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3997 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3998 of additional information is limited.
3999
4000 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4001 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4002
4003 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4004
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004005
4006option log-separate-errors
4007no option log-separate-errors
4008 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4010 yes | yes | yes | no
4011 Arguments : none
4012
4013 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4014 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4015 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4016 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4017 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4018 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4019 provides very important information.
4020
4021 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4022 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4023 error logs.
4024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004025 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004026 logging.
4027
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004028
4029option logasap
4030no option logasap
4031 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4033 yes | yes | yes | no
4034 Arguments : none
4035
4036 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4037 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4038 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4039 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4040 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4041 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4042 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004043 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004044 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4045 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4046
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004047 Examples :
4048 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4049 mode http
4050 option httplog
4051 option logasap
4052 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4053
4054 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4055 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4056 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4057 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004059 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004060 logging.
4061
4062
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004063option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4064 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4066 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004067 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004068 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4069 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004070
4071 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4072 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4073 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4074 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4075 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4076 in the MySQL table, like this :
4077
4078 USE mysql;
4079 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4080 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4081
4082 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4083 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4084 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4085 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4086 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4087 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4088 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4089 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4090 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4091
4092 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4093 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004094
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004095 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004096
4097 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4098 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4099 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4100 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4101 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4102 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4103
4104 See also: "option httpchk"
4105
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01004106option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4107 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4109 yes | no | yes | yes
4110 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004111 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4112 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01004113
4114 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4115 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4116 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4117 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4118
4119 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004120
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004121option nolinger
4122no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004123 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004124 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4125 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004126 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004127
4128 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4129 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4130 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4131 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4132 connections.
4133
4134 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4135 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4136 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4137 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4138 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4139 this too.
4140
4141 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4142 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4143 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4144
4145 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4146 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4147 for servers.
4148
4149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4151
4152
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004153option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4154 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4156 yes | yes | yes | yes
4157 Arguments :
4158 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4159 matching <network>
4160 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4161 header name.
4162
4163 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4164 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4165 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4166 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4167 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4168 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4169 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4170 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4171 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4172 possible that the client has already brought one.
4173
4174 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4175 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4176 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4177 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4178 header and requires different one.
4179
4180 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4181 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4182 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4183 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4184 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4185 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4186 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4187
4188 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4189 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4190 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4191 both are defined.
4192
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004193 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4194 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4195 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4196 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4197 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004198
4199 Examples :
4200 # Original Destination address
4201 frontend www
4202 mode http
4203 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4204
4205 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4206 backend www
4207 mode http
4208 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4209
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004210 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4211 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004212
4213
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004214option persist
4215no option persist
4216 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4217 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4218 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004219 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004220
4221 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4222 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4223 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4224 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4225 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4226 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4227 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4228 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4229 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4230 redirected to another valid server.
4231
4232 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4233 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4234
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004235 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004236
4237
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004238option redispatch
4239no option redispatch
4240 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4241 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4242 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004243 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004244
4245 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4246 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4247 be able to access the service anymore.
4248
4249 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4250 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4251
4252 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4253 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4254 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004255
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004256 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4257 "redisp" keywords.
4258
4259 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4260 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4261
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004262 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004263
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004264
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004265option redis-check
4266 Use redis health checks for server testing
4267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4268 yes | no | yes | yes
4269 Arguments : none
4270
4271 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4272 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4273 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4274 find the "+PONG" response message.
4275
4276 Example :
4277 option redis-check
4278
4279 See also : "option httpchk"
4280
4281
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004282option smtpchk
4283option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4284 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4286 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004287 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004288 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4289 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4290 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4291
4292 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4293 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4294 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4295
4296 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4297 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4298 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4299 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4300 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4301 dead server.
4302
4303 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4304 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4305 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4306 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4307
4308 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4309 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4310 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4311 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4312 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4313
4314 Example :
4315 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4316
4317 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4318
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004320option socket-stats
4321no option socket-stats
4322
4323 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4325 yes | yes | yes | no
4326
4327 Arguments : none
4328
4329
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004330option splice-auto
4331no option splice-auto
4332 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4334 yes | yes | yes | yes
4335 Arguments : none
4336
4337 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4338 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4339 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4340 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004341 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004342 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4343 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4344 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4345 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4346
4347 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4348 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4349 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4350 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4351 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4352 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4353 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4354 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4355 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4356 keyword.
4357
4358 Example :
4359 option splice-auto
4360
4361 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4362 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4363
4364 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4365 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4366
4367
4368option splice-request
4369no option splice-request
4370 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4372 yes | yes | yes | yes
4373 Arguments : none
4374
4375 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004376 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004377 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4378 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4379 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4380 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4381
4382 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4383
4384 Example :
4385 option splice-request
4386
4387 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4388 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4389
4390 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4391 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4392
4393
4394option splice-response
4395no option splice-response
4396 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4398 yes | yes | yes | yes
4399 Arguments : none
4400
4401 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004402 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004403 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4404 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4405 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4406 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4407
4408 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4409
4410 Example :
4411 option splice-response
4412
4413 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4414 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4415
4416 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4417 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4418
4419
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004420option srvtcpka
4421no option srvtcpka
4422 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4424 yes | no | yes | yes
4425 Arguments : none
4426
4427 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4428 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4429 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4430 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4431
4432 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4433 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4434 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4435 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4436
4437 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4438 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4439 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4440 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4441 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4442
4443 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4444
4445 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4446 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4447 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4448
4449 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4450 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4451
4452 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4453
4454
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004455option ssl-hello-chk
4456 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4458 yes | no | yes | yes
4459 Arguments : none
4460
4461 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4462 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4463 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4464 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4465 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4466 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4467 hello message.
4468
4469 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4470 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4471 messages, which is appreciable.
4472
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004473 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4474 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4475 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004476
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004477 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4478
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004479
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004480option tcp-smart-accept
4481no option tcp-smart-accept
4482 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4484 yes | yes | yes | no
4485 Arguments : none
4486
4487 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4488 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4489 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4490 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4491 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4492 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4493
4494 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4495 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4496 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4497 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4498
4499 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4500 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4501 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4502 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4503
4504 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4505 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4506 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4507
4508 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4509 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4510 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4511
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004512 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4513
4514
4515option tcp-smart-connect
4516no option tcp-smart-connect
4517 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4519 yes | no | yes | yes
4520 Arguments : none
4521
4522 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4523 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4524 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4525 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4526 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4527
4528 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4529 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4530 complex.
4531
4532 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4533 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4534 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4535
4536 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4537 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4538
4539 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4540
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004541
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004542option tcpka
4543 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4545 yes | yes | yes | yes
4546 Arguments : none
4547
4548 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4549 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4550 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4551 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4552
4553 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4554 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4555 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4556 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4557
4558 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4559 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4560 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4561 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4562 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4563
4564 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4565
4566 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4567 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4568 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4569 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4570 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4571 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4572 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4573 backends.
4574
4575 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4576
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004577
4578option tcplog
4579 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4581 yes | yes | yes | yes
4582 Arguments : none
4583
4584 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4585 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4586 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4587 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4588 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4589 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4590 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4591 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4592
4593 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004595 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004596
4597
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004598option transparent
4599no option transparent
4600 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004602 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004603 Arguments : none
4604
4605 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4606 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4607 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4608 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4609 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4610 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4611 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4612 appropriate server.
4613
4614 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4615 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4616
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004617 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004618 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004619
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004620
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004621persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004622persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004623 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4625 yes | no | yes | yes
4626 Arguments :
4627 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004628 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4629 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004630
4631 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4632 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4633 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4634 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4635 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4636 forwarded to this server.
4637
4638 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4639 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4640 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004641 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004642 a single "listen" section.
4643
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004644 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4645 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4646 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4647
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004648 Example :
4649 listen tse-farm
4650 bind :3389
4651 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4652 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4653 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4654 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4655 persist rdp-cookie
4656 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004657 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004658 balance rdp-cookie
4659 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4660 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4661
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004662 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4663 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004664
4665
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004666rate-limit sessions <rate>
4667 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4669 yes | yes | yes | no
4670 Arguments :
4671 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4672 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4673
4674 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4675 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4676 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4677 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4678 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4679 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4680
4681 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4682 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4683 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4684 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4685
4686 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4687 listen smtp
4688 mode tcp
4689 bind :25
4690 rate-limit sessions 10
4691 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4692
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004693 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4694 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4695 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004696
4697 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4698
4699
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004700redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4701redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4702redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004703 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4705 no | yes | yes | yes
4706
4707 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004708 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004709
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004710 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004711 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4712 the HTTP "Location" header.
4713
4714 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4715 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4716 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4717 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4718 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4719 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4720
4721 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4722 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4723 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4724 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4725 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4726 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4727 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4728 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4729 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004730
4731 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01004732 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
4733 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
4734 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
4735 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
4736 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
4737 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
4738 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
4739 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004740
4741 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4742 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4743
4744 - "drop-query"
4745 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4746 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4747 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4748 with a location-type redirect.
4749
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004750 - "append-slash"
4751 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4752 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4753 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4754 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4755
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004756 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4757 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4758 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4759 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4760 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4761 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4762 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4763
4764 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4765 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4766 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4767 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4768 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4769 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4770 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004771
4772 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4773 acl clear dst_port 80
4774 acl secure dst_port 8080
4775 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004776 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004777 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004778 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4779
4780 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004781 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4782 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4783 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004784 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004785
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004786 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4787 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4788 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4789
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004790 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004791 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004793 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004794
4795
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004796redisp (deprecated)
4797redispatch (deprecated)
4798 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4799 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4800 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004801 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004802
4803 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4804 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4805 be able to access the service anymore.
4806
4807 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4808 redistribute them to a working server.
4809
4810 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4811 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4812 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004813
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004814 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4815 "option redispatch" instead.
4816
4817 See also : "option redispatch"
4818
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004819
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004820reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004821 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4823 no | yes | yes | yes
4824 Arguments :
4825 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4826 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004827 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004828
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004829 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4830 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4831
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004832 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4833 the last header of an HTTP request.
4834
4835 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4836 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4837 responses.
4838
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004839 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4840 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4841 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4842
4843 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4844 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004845
4846
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004847reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4848reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004849 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4851 no | yes | yes | yes
4852 Arguments :
4853 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4854 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4855 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4856 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4857 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4858 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4859 ignores case.
4860
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004861 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4862 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4863
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004864 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4865 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4866 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4867 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004868 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004869
4870 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4871 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4872
4873 Example :
4874 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4875 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4876 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4877
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004878 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4879 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004880
4881
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004882reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4883reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004884 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4886 no | yes | yes | yes
4887 Arguments :
4888 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4889 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4890 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4891 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4892 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4893 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4894
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004895 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4896 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4897
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004898 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4899 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4900 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4901 next servers.
4902
4903 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4904 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4905 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4906
4907 Example :
4908 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4909 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4910 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4911
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004912 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4913 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004914
4915
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004916reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4917reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004918 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4920 no | yes | yes | yes
4921 Arguments :
4922 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4923 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4924 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4925 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4926 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4927 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4928 case.
4929
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004930 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4931 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4932
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004933 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4934 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4935 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4936 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004937 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004938
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004939 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004940 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004941 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004942
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004943 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4944 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4945
4946 Example :
4947 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4948 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4949 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4950
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004951 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4952 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004953
4954
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004955reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4956reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004957 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4959 no | yes | yes | yes
4960 Arguments :
4961 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4962 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4963 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4964 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4965 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4966 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4967 case.
4968
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004969 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4970 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4971
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004972 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4973 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4974 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4975 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4976
4977 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4978 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4979
4980 Example :
4981 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4982 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4983 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4984 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4985
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004986 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4987 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004988
4989
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004990reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4991reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004992 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4994 no | yes | yes | yes
4995 Arguments :
4996 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4997 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4998 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4999 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5000 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5001 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5002
5003 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5004 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5005 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5006 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005007 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005008
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005009 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5010 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5011
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005012 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5013 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5014 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5015
5016 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5017 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5018 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5019 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5020 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5021
5022 Example :
5023 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005024 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005025 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5026 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5027
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005028 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5029 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005030
5031
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005032reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5033reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005034 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5036 no | yes | yes | yes
5037 Arguments :
5038 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5039 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5040 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5041 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5042 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5043 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5044 ignores case.
5045
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005046 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5047 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5048
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005049 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5050 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005051 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5052 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5053 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005054 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5055 not set.
5056
5057 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5058 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5059 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5060 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5061 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5062
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005063 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005064 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5065 # block all others.
5066 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5067 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5068
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005069 # block bad guys
5070 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5071 reqitarpit . if badguys
5072
5073 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5074 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005075
5076
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005077retries <value>
5078 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5079 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5080 yes | no | yes | yes
5081 Arguments :
5082 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5083 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5084 default value is 3.
5085
5086 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5087 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5088 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5089
5090 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5091 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5092
5093 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5094 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5095
5096 See also : "option redispatch"
5097
5098
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005099rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005100 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5102 no | yes | yes | yes
5103 Arguments :
5104 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5105 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005106 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005107
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005108 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5109 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5110
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005111 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5112 the last header of an HTTP response.
5113
5114 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5115 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5116 responses.
5117
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005118 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5119 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005120
5121
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005122rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5123rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005124 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5126 no | yes | yes | yes
5127 Arguments :
5128 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5129 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5130 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5131 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5132 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5133 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5134 ignores case.
5135
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005136 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5137 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5138
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005139 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5140 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005141 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005142 client.
5143
5144 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5145 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5146 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5147
5148 Example :
5149 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005150 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005151
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005152 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5153 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005154
5155
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005156rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5157rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005158 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5160 no | yes | yes | yes
5161 Arguments :
5162 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5163 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5164 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5165 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5166 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5167 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5168 ignores case.
5169
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005170 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5171 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5172
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005173 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5174 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5175 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5176 case-sensitive.
5177
5178 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005179 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5180 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5181 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005182
5183 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5184 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5185
5186 Example :
5187 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5188 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5189
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005190 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5191 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005192
5193
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005194rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5195rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005196 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5198 no | yes | yes | yes
5199 Arguments :
5200 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5201 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5202 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5203 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5204 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5205 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5206 ignores case.
5207
5208 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5209 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5210 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5211 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005212 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005213
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005214 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5215 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5216
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005217 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5218 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5219 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5220
5221 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5222 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5223 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5224 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5225 are not case-sensitive.
5226
5227 Example :
5228 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5229 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5230
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005231 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5232 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005233
5234
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005235server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005236 Declare a server in a backend
5237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5238 no | no | yes | yes
5239 Arguments :
5240 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005241 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005242 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005243
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005244 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5245 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5246 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5247 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005248 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5249 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5250 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5251 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5252 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005253 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5254 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5255 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5256 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5257 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5258 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5259 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005260 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5261 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5262 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5263 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005264
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005265 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005266 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5267 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5268 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5269 adding this value to the client's port.
5270
5271 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5272 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005273 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005274
5275 Examples :
5276 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5277 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005278 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005279 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5280 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5281 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005282
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005283 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5284 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005285
5286
5287source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005288source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005289source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005290 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5292 yes | no | yes | yes
5293 Arguments :
5294 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5295 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005296
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005297 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005298 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5299 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5300 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5301 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5302 supported prefixes are :
5303 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5304 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5305 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005306 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5307 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5308 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5309 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005310
5311 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5312 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005313 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5314 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5315 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005316
5317 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5318 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5319 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5320 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5321 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5322 <addr>.
5323
5324 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5325 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5326 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5327 port.
5328
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005329 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5330 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5331 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5332 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005333 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005334 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5335 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5336 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5337 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5338 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5339 HTTP header.
5340
5341 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5342 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005343 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005344 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5345 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5346 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5347 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5348 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5349 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5350 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5351
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005352 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5353 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5354 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5355 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5356 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5357 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5358
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005359 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5360 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5361 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5362 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5363
5364 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5365 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5366 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5367 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5368 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5369 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5370
5371 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5372 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5373 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5374 there are two methods :
5375
5376 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5377 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5378 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5379 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5380 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5381 of the client ranges may be used.
5382
5383 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5384 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5385 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5386 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5387 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5388 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5389 same session.
5390
5391 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5392 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5393 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5394 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5395 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5396 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5397
5398 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5399 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5400 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005401 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005402
5403 Examples :
5404 backend private
5405 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5406 source 192.168.1.200
5407
5408 backend transparent_ssl1
5409 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5410 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5411
5412 backend transparent_ssl2
5413 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5414 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5415 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5416
5417 backend transparent_ssl3
5418 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5419 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5420 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5421
5422 backend transparent_smtp
5423 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5424 # with Tproxy version 4.
5425 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5426
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005427 backend transparent_http
5428 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5429 # proxy.
5430 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5431
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005432 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005433 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5434
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005435
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005436srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5437 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5439 yes | no | yes | yes
5440 Arguments :
5441 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5442 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5443 as explained at the top of this document.
5444
5445 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5446 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5447 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5448 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5449 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5450 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5451 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5452
5453 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5454 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5455 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5456 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5457 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005458 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005459 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005460 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005461
5462 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5463 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5464 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5465 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5466 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5467 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5468
5469 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5470 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5471
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005472 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5473 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005474
5475
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005476stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5477 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5479 no | no | yes | yes
5480
5481 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5482 matched.
5483
5484 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5485 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5486
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005487 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5488 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5489 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5490
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005491 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5492 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5493 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5494 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005495
5496 Example :
5497 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5498 backend stats_localhost
5499 stats enable
5500 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5501
5502 Example :
5503 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5504 backend stats_auth
5505 stats enable
5506 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5507 stats admin if TRUE
5508
5509 Example :
5510 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5511 userlist stats-auth
5512 group admin users admin
5513 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5514 group readonly users haproxy
5515 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5516
5517 backend stats_auth
5518 stats enable
5519 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5520 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5521 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5522 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5523
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005524 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5525 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5526 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005527
5528
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005529stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5530 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5532 yes | no | yes | yes
5533 Arguments :
5534 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5535
5536 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5537
5538 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5539 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5540 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5541 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5542 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5543 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5544
5545 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5546 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5547 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005548 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005549
5550 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5551 report using "stats scope".
5552
5553 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5554 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5555 unobvious parameters.
5556
5557 Example :
5558 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5559 backend public_www
5560 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5561 stats enable
5562 stats hide-version
5563 stats scope .
5564 stats uri /admin?stats
5565 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5566 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5567 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5568
5569 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5570 backend private_monitoring
5571 stats enable
5572 stats uri /admin?stats
5573 stats refresh 5s
5574
5575 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5576
5577
5578stats enable
5579 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5581 yes | no | yes | yes
5582 Arguments : none
5583
5584 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5585 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5586 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5587 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5588 - stats auth : no authentication
5589 - stats scope : no restriction
5590
5591 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5592 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5593 unobvious parameters.
5594
5595 Example :
5596 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5597 backend public_www
5598 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5599 stats enable
5600 stats hide-version
5601 stats scope .
5602 stats uri /admin?stats
5603 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5604 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5605 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5606
5607 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5608 backend private_monitoring
5609 stats enable
5610 stats uri /admin?stats
5611 stats refresh 5s
5612
5613 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5614
5615
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005616stats hide-version
5617 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5619 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005620 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005621
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005622 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5623 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5624 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5625 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5626 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5627 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005628
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005629 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5630 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5631 unobvious parameters.
5632
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005633 Example :
5634 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5635 backend public_www
5636 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005637 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005638 stats hide-version
5639 stats scope .
5640 stats uri /admin?stats
5641 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5642 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5643 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005644
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005645 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5646 backend private_monitoring
5647 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005648 stats uri /admin?stats
5649 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005650
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005651 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005652
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005653
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005654stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5655 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5656 Access control for statistics
5657
5658 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5659 no | no | yes | yes
5660
5661 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5662 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5663 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5664 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5665 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5666 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5667
5668 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5669 instance.
5670
5671 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5672 about ACL usage.
5673
5674
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005675stats realm <realm>
5676 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5678 yes | no | yes | yes
5679 Arguments :
5680 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5681 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5682 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5683
5684 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5685 using a backslash ('\').
5686
5687 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5688 only related to authentication.
5689
5690 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5691 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5692 unobvious parameters.
5693
5694 Example :
5695 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5696 backend public_www
5697 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5698 stats enable
5699 stats hide-version
5700 stats scope .
5701 stats uri /admin?stats
5702 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5703 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5704 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5705
5706 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5707 backend private_monitoring
5708 stats enable
5709 stats uri /admin?stats
5710 stats refresh 5s
5711
5712 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5713
5714
5715stats refresh <delay>
5716 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5718 yes | no | yes | yes
5719 Arguments :
5720 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5721 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5722 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5723 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5724 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5725 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5726
5727 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5728 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5729 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5730 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5731
5732 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5733 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5734 unobvious parameters.
5735
5736 Example :
5737 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5738 backend public_www
5739 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5740 stats enable
5741 stats hide-version
5742 stats scope .
5743 stats uri /admin?stats
5744 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5745 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5746 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5747
5748 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5749 backend private_monitoring
5750 stats enable
5751 stats uri /admin?stats
5752 stats refresh 5s
5753
5754 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5755
5756
5757stats scope { <name> | "." }
5758 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5760 yes | no | yes | yes
5761 Arguments :
5762 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5763 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5764 section in which the statement appears.
5765
5766 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5767 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5768 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5769 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5770 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5771 exists.
5772
5773 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5774 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5775 unobvious parameters.
5776
5777 Example :
5778 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5779 backend public_www
5780 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5781 stats enable
5782 stats hide-version
5783 stats scope .
5784 stats uri /admin?stats
5785 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5786 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5787 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5788
5789 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5790 backend private_monitoring
5791 stats enable
5792 stats uri /admin?stats
5793 stats refresh 5s
5794
5795 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5796
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005797
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005798stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005799 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5801 yes | no | yes | yes
5802
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005803 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005804 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5805
5806 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5807 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5808
5809 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5810 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005811 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005812
5813 Example :
5814 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5815 backend private_monitoring
5816 stats enable
5817 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5818 stats uri /admin?stats
5819 stats refresh 5s
5820
5821 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5822 global section.
5823
5824
5825stats show-legends
5826 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5827 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5828 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5829 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5830 - IP (socket, server)
5831 - cookie (backend, server)
5832
5833 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5834 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005835 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005836
5837 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5838
5839
5840stats show-node [ <name> ]
5841 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5843 yes | no | yes | yes
5844 Arguments:
5845 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5846 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5847
5848 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5849 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005850 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005851
5852 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5853 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5854 unobvious parameters.
5855
5856 Example:
5857 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5858 backend private_monitoring
5859 stats enable
5860 stats show-node Europe-1
5861 stats uri /admin?stats
5862 stats refresh 5s
5863
5864 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5865 section.
5866
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005867
5868stats uri <prefix>
5869 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5871 yes | no | yes | yes
5872 Arguments :
5873 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5874 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5875 query string.
5876
5877 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5878 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5879 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5880 possible to reach it in the application.
5881
5882 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005883 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005884 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5885 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5886 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5887 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5888
5889 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5890 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5891 an address or a port to statistics only.
5892
5893 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5894 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5895 unobvious parameters.
5896
5897 Example :
5898 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5899 backend public_www
5900 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5901 stats enable
5902 stats hide-version
5903 stats scope .
5904 stats uri /admin?stats
5905 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5906 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5907 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5908
5909 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5910 backend private_monitoring
5911 stats enable
5912 stats uri /admin?stats
5913 stats refresh 5s
5914
5915 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5916
5917
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005918stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5919 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005921 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005922
5923 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02005924 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005925 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5926 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5927 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5928
5929 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5930 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5931 the "stick-table" statement.
5932
5933 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5934 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5935 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5936 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5937 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5938
5939 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5940 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5941 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5942 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5943 transformation rules.
5944
5945 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5946 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5947 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5948 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5949 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5950 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5951 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5952
5953 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5954 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5955 ACL based conditions.
5956
5957 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5958 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5959 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5960 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5961
5962 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5963 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5964 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5965 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5966
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005967 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5968 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5969 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5970
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005971 Example :
5972 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5973 # last 30 minutes
5974 backend pop
5975 mode tcp
5976 balance roundrobin
5977 stick store-request src
5978 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5979 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5980 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5981
5982 backend smtp
5983 mode tcp
5984 balance roundrobin
5985 stick match src table pop
5986 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5987 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5988
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005989 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5990 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005991
5992
5993stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5994 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5996 no | no | yes | yes
5997
5998 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5999 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6000 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6001 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6002
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006003 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6004 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6005 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6006
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006007 Examples :
6008 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006009 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006010
6011 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6012 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6013 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6014
6015
6016 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6017 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6018 backend http
6019 mode http
6020 balance roundrobin
6021 stick on src table https
6022 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6023 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6024 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6025
6026 backend https
6027 mode tcp
6028 balance roundrobin
6029 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6030 stick on src
6031 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6032 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6033
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006034 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006035
6036
6037stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6038 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6040 no | no | yes | yes
6041
6042 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006043 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006044 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6045 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6046 server is selected.
6047
6048 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6049 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6050 the "stick-table" statement.
6051
6052 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6053 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6054 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6055 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6056 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6057 address.
6058
6059 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6060 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6061 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6062 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6063 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6064 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6065 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6066 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6067 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6068 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6069
6070 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6071 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6072 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6073 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6074 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6075 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6076 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6077
6078 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6079 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6080 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6081 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6082
6083 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6084 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6085 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6086 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6087 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6088 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6089 another protocol or access method.
6090
6091 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6092 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6093 the request.
6094
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006095 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6096 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6097 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6098
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006099 Example :
6100 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6101 # last 30 minutes
6102 backend pop
6103 mode tcp
6104 balance roundrobin
6105 stick store-request src
6106 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6107 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6108 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6109
6110 backend smtp
6111 mode tcp
6112 balance roundrobin
6113 stick match src table pop
6114 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6115 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6116
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006117 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6118 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006119
6120
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006121stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006122 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6123 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006124 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
6125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006126 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006127
6128 Arguments :
6129 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6130 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6131 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6132 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6133
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006134 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6135 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6136 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6137 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6138
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006139 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6140 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6141 instance.
6142
6143 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6144 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6145 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6146 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6147 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6148 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006149 to 32 characters.
6150
6151 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6152 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6153 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6154 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6155 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6156 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006157
6158 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006159 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6160 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006161 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6162 increase.
6163
6164 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006165 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6166 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6167 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006168
6169 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6170 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6171 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6172 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6173 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6174 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6175 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6176 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6177 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6178 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6179 parameter (see below).
6180
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006181 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6182 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6183 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6184 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6185 soft restart.
6186
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006187 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6188
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006189 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6190 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6191 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6192 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6193 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006194 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006195 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6196 if not expiration delay is specified.
6197
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006198 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6199 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6200 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6201 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006202 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6203 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6204 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6205 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6206 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6207 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6208 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6209 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6210 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6211 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6212 types and their arguments.
6213
6214 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6215 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6216 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6217 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6218
6219 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6220 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6221 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6222 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6223
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006224 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6225 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6226 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6227 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6228 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6229 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6230
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006231 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6232 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6233 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6234 they were received.
6235
6236 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6237 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6238 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6239 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6240 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6241
6242 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6243 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6244 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6245 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6246 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6247
6248 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6249 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6250 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6251
6252 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6253 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6254 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6255 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6256 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6257
6258 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6259 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6260 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6261 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6262 the client side.
6263
6264 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6265 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6266 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6267 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6268 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6269 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6270 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6271
6272 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6273 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6274 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6275 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6276 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6277 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6278 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6279
6280 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6281 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6282 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6283 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6284 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6285 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6286
6287 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6288 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6289 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6290 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6291
6292 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6293 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6294 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6295 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6296 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6297 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6298 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6299 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6300 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6301 recommended for better fairness.
6302
6303 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6304 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6305 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6306 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6307
6308 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6309 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6310 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6311 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6312 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6313 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6314 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6315 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6316 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6317 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006318
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006319 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6320 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006321 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6322 reference it.
6323
6324 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6325 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6326 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6327 as an exclusive stickiness.
6328
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006329 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6330 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6331 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6332 something that can be ignored.
6333
6334 Example:
6335 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6336 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6337 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6338 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6339
6340 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006341 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006342
6343
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006344stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6345 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6347 no | no | yes | yes
6348
6349 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006350 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006351 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6352 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6353 server is selected.
6354
6355 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6356 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6357 the "stick-table" statement.
6358
6359 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6360 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6361 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6362 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6363
6364 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6365 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6366 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6367 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6368 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6369 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006370 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006371 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6372 rules.
6373
6374 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6375 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6376 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6377 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6378 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6379 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6380 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6381
6382 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6383 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6384 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6385 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6386
6387 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6388 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6389 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6390 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6391 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6392 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6393 another protocol or access method.
6394
6395 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6396
6397 Example :
6398 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6399 backend https
6400 mode tcp
6401 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006402 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006403 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006404
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006405 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6406 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6407
6408 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6409 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6410 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6411
6412 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6413 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006414
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006415 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6416 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6417 # at offset 44.
6418
6419 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6420 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6421
6422 # Learn on response if server hello.
6423 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006424
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006425 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6426 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6427
6428 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6429 extraction.
6430
6431
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006432tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6433 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6435 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006436 Arguments :
6437 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006438 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6439 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006440
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006441 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006442
6443 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6444 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006445 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6446 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6447 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6448 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6449 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6450 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006451
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006452 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6453 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6454 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6455 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006456
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006457 Three types of actions are supported :
6458 - accept :
6459 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6460 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6461 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006462
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006463 - reject :
6464 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6465 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6466 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6467 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6468 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6469 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6470 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6471 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6472 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6473 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6474 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6475 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006476
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006477 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6478 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6479 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6480 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
6481 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
6482 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
6483 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
6484 hosts.
6485
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006486 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006487 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6488 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6489 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006490 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6491 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006492 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006493 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
6494 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
6495 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
6496 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
6497 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006498
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006499 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006500 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006501 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006502 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6503 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6504 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6505 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006506
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006507 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6508 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6509 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6510 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006512 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6513 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6514 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6515 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6516 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006517 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6518 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6519 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6520 layer7 information is extracted.
6521
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006522 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6523 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6524 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6525 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6526 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006527
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006528 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6529 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6530 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006531
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006532 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6533 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6534 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006535
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006536 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006537 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006538 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006539
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006540 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6541 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6542 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006543
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006544 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006545 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6546 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006547
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006548 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
6549
6550 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
6551
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006552 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6553
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006554 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006555
6556
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006557tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6558 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006560 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006561 Arguments :
6562 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006563 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6564 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006565 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006566
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006567 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006568
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006569 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6570 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6571 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6572 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6573 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006574
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006575 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6576 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6577 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6578 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6579 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6580 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6581 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6582 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6583 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006584
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006585 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6586 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6587 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6588 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006589
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006590 Three types of actions are supported :
6591 - accept :
6592 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006593 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006594
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006595 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6596 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006597
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006598 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6599 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6600 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006601 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6602 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6603 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6604 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006605 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc0 pointer to track per-frontend
6606 counters and track-sc1 to track per-backend counters, but this is just a
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006607 guideline and all counters may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006609 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006610 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6611 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006612
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006613 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006614 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6615 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6616 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6617 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6618 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006619
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006620 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6621 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6622 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6623 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6624
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006625 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006626 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6627 # and reject everything else.
6628 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6629 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006630 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006631 tcp-request content reject
6632
6633 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006634 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6635 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6636 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006637 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006638
6639 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6640 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6641 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006642 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006643 tcp-request content reject
6644
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006645 Example:
6646 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6647 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006648 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006649
6650 Example:
6651 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6652 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006653 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006654
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006655 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6656 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6657
6658 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006659 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006660 # protecting all our sites
6661 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006662 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6663 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006664 ...
6665 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6666
6667 backend http_dynamic
6668 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006669 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006670 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006671 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
6672 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
6673 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006674 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006676 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006677
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006678 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006679
6680
6681tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6682 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006684 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006685 Arguments :
6686 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6687 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6688 as explained at the top of this document.
6689
6690 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6691 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6692 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6693 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6694 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6695
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006696 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6697 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6698 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6699 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6700
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006701 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6702 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006703 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006704 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006705 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6706 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6707 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6708 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006709
6710 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6711 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6712 it pass through unaffected.
6713
6714 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6715 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6716 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006717 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006718 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6719 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006720 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6721 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6722 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006723
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006724 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006725 "timeout client".
6726
6727
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006728tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6729 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6731 no | no | yes | yes
6732 Arguments :
6733 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006734 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006735
6736 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6737
6738 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6739 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6740 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006741 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
6742 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006743
6744 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6745
6746 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6747 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6748 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6749 inserted.
6750
6751 Two types of actions are supported :
6752 - accept :
6753 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6754 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6755 the rules evaluation.
6756
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006757 - close :
6758 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
6759 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
6760 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
6761 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
6762 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
6763 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
6764 connections which take signifiant resources on servers with certain
6765 protocols.
6766
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006767 - reject :
6768 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6769 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006770 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006771
6772 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6773 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6774 for changing the default action to a reject.
6775
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006776 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6777 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6778 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6779 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006780 period.
6781
6782 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6783
6784 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6785
6786
6787tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6788 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6790 no | no | yes | yes
6791 Arguments :
6792 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6793 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6794 as explained at the top of this document.
6795
6796 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6797
6798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006799timeout check <timeout>
6800 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6801 established.
6802
6803 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6804 yes | no | yes | yes
6805 Arguments:
6806 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6807 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6808 as explained at the top of this document.
6809
6810 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6811 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6812 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6813 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006814 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6815 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6816 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006817
6818 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6819 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6820
6821 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6822 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006823 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006824
6825 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6826 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6827 forget about it.
6828
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006829 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6830 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006831
6832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006833timeout client <timeout>
6834timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6835 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6837 yes | yes | yes | no
6838 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006839 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006840 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6841 as explained at the top of this document.
6842
6843 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6844 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6845 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6846 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6847 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6848 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6849 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6850 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006851 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006852 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006853 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6854 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6855 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006856
6857 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6858 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6859 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6860 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6861 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6862 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6863
6864 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6865 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6866 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6867
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006868 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006869
6870
6871timeout connect <timeout>
6872timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6873 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6875 yes | no | yes | yes
6876 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006877 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006878 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6879 as explained at the top of this document.
6880
6881 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006882 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006883 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006884 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006885 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6886 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006887
6888 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6889 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6890 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6891 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6892 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6893 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6894
6895 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6896 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6897 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6898
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006899 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6900 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006901
6902
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006903timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6904 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6906 yes | yes | yes | yes
6907 Arguments :
6908 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6909 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6910 as explained at the top of this document.
6911
6912 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6913 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6914 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6915 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6916 once the request has started to present itself.
6917
6918 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6919 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6920 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6921 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6922 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6923
6924 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6925 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6926 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6927 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6928
6929 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6930 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6931 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6932 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6933 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006934 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006935
6936 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6937 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6938 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6939 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6940
6941 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6942
6943
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006944timeout http-request <timeout>
6945 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006947 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006948 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006949 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006950 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6951 as explained at the top of this document.
6952
6953 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6954 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6955 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6956 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6957 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6958 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6959 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6960 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6961
6962 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6963 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006964 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6965 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006966
6967 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6968 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6969 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6970 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6971 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6972
6973 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006974 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6975 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6976 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006977
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006978 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006979
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006980
6981timeout queue <timeout>
6982 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6984 yes | no | yes | yes
6985 Arguments :
6986 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6987 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6988 as explained at the top of this document.
6989
6990 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6991 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6992 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6993 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6994 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6995
6996 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6997 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6998 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6999 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7000
7001 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7002
7003
7004timeout server <timeout>
7005timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7006 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7008 yes | no | yes | yes
7009 Arguments :
7010 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7011 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7012 as explained at the top of this document.
7013
7014 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7015 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7016 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7017 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7018 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7019 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7020 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7021
7022 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7023 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7024 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7025 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7026 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007027 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007028 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007029 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7030 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7031 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7032 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007033
7034 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7035 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7036 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7037 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7038 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7039 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7040
7041 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7042 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7043 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7044
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007045 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007046
7047
7048timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007049 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7051 yes | yes | yes | yes
7052 Arguments :
7053 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7054 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7055 as explained at the top of this document.
7056
7057 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7058 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7059 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7060
7061 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7062 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7063 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7064 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007065 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007066
7067 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7068
7069
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007070timeout tunnel <timeout>
7071 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7073 yes | no | yes | yes
7074 Arguments :
7075 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7076 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7077 as explained at the top of this document.
7078
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007079 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007080 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7081 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7082 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7083 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7084 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7085 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7086 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7087 specified.
7088
7089 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7090 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7091 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7092 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7093 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7094
7095 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7096 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7097 forget about it.
7098
7099 Example :
7100 defaults http
7101 option http-server-close
7102 timeout connect 5s
7103 timeout client 30s
7104 timeout client 30s
7105 timeout server 30s
7106 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7107
7108 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7109
7110
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007111transparent (deprecated)
7112 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007114 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007115 Arguments : none
7116
7117 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7118 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7119 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7120 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7121 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7122 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7123 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7124 appropriate server.
7125
7126 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7127
7128 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7129 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7130
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007131 See also: "option transparent"
7132
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007133unique-id-format <string>
7134 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7136 yes | yes | yes | no
7137 Arguments :
7138 <string> is a log-format string.
7139
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007140 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7141 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7142 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7143 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007144
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007145 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7146 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7147 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7148 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7149 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7150 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7151 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7152 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007153
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007154 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7155 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007156
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007157 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007158
7159 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7160
7161 will generate:
7162
7163 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7164
7165 See also: "unique-id-header"
7166
7167unique-id-header <name>
7168 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7170 yes | yes | yes | no
7171 Arguments :
7172 <name> is the name of the header.
7173
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007174 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7175 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007176
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007177 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007178
7179 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7180 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7181
7182 will generate:
7183
7184 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7185
7186 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007187
7188use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7189use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007190 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7192 no | yes | yes | no
7193 Arguments :
7194 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007196 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007197
7198 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7199 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7200 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007201 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7202 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7203 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7204 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007205
7206 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7207 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7208 assign the backend.
7209
7210 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7211 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7212 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7213 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7214 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7215 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7216
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007217 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007218 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007219 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7220 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7221 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7222
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007223 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007224
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007225
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007226use-server <server> if <condition>
7227use-server <server> unless <condition>
7228 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7230 no | no | yes | yes
7231 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007232 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007233
7234 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7235
7236 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7237 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7238 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7239
7240 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7241 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7242 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7243 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7244 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7245 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7246 matches will assign the server.
7247
7248 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7249 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7250 with the next rules until one matches.
7251
7252 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7253 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7254 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7255 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7256
7257 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7258 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7259 stripped.
7260
7261 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7262 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7263 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7264 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7265
7266 Example :
7267 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7268 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7269 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7270 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7271 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7272 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7273 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7274 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7275 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7276
7277 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7278
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007279
72805. Bind and Server options
7281--------------------------
7282
7283The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7284depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7285settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7286written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7287described in this section.
7288
7289
72905.1. Bind options
7291-----------------
7292
7293The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7294as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7295no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7296parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7297while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7298provided immediately after the setting name.
7299
7300The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7301
7302accept-proxy
7303 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7304 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7305 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7306 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7307 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7308 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7309 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7310 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7311 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007312 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7313 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007314
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007315alpn <protocols>
7316 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7317 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7318 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7319 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7320 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7321 initial NPN extension.
7322
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007323backlog <backlog>
7324 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7325 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7326
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007327ecdhe <named curve>
7328 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007329 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7330 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007331
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007332ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007333 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7334 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7335 client's certificate.
7336
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007337ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7339 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7340 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7341 error is ignored.
7342
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007343ciphers <ciphers>
7344 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7345 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7346 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7347 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7348 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7349
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007350crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007351 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7352 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7353 to verify client's certificate.
7354
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007355crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7357 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7358 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7359 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7360 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7361 file.
7362
7363 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7364 are loaded.
7365
7366 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7367 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7368 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7369 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7370 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7371 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7372 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7373 www.sub.example.org).
7374
7375 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7376 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7377 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7378 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7379 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7380
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007381 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007382
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007383 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7384 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7385 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7386 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7387 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7388 clients).
7389
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007390crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007391 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7392 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7393 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7394 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007395
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007396crt-list <file>
7397 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007398 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7399 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007400
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007401 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007402
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007403 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7404 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7405 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7406 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7407 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7408 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7409 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7410 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007411
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007412defer-accept
7413 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7414 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7415 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7416 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7417 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7418 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7419 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7420 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7421 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7422 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7423 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7424
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007425force-sslv3
7426 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7427 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7428 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7429
7430force-tlsv10
7431 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7432 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7433
7434force-tlsv11
7435 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7436 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7437
7438force-tlsv12
7439 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7440 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7441
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007442gid <gid>
7443 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7444 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7445 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7446 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7447 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7448
7449group <group>
7450 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7451 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7452 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7453 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7454 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7455
7456id <id>
7457 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7458 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7459 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7460 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7461
7462interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007463 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7464 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7465 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7466 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7467 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7468 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7469 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007470
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007471level <level>
7472 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7473 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7474 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7475 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7476 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7477 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7478 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7479 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7480 counters).
7481 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7482 all counters).
7483
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007484maxconn <maxconn>
7485 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7486 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7487 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7488 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7489 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7490 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7491 eat all memory.
7492
7493mode <mode>
7494 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7495 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7496 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7497 UNIX sockets.
7498
7499mss <maxseg>
7500 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7501 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7502 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7503 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7504 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7505 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7506 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7507 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7508 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7509 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7510 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7511
7512name <name>
7513 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7514 page.
7515
7516nice <nice>
7517 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7518 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7519 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7520 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7521 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7522 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7523 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7524 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7525 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7526 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7527 one for an RDP socket.
7528
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007529no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007530 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7531 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7532 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007533 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7534 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007535
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007536no-tls-tickets
7537 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7538 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7539 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7540 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7541
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007542no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007543 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007544 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7545 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7546 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7547 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007548
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007549no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007550 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007551 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7552 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7553 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7554 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007555
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007556no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007557 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007558 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7559 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7560 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7561 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007562
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007563npn <protocols>
7564 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7565 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7566 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7567 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007568 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
7569 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007570
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007571ssl
7572 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7573 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7574 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7575 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7576 to deciphered contents.
7577
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007578strict-sni
7579 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7580 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7581 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7582 See the "crt" option for more information.
7583
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007584tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007585 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007586 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7587 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7588 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7589 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7590 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7591 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7592 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02007593 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
7594 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
7595 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007596
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007597transparent
7598 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7599 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7600 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7601 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7602 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7603 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7604 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7605 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7606 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7607 so check for support with your vendor.
7608
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007609v4v6
7610 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7611 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7612 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7613 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7614 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7615
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007616v6only
7617 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7618 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7619 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007620 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7621 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007622
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007623uid <uid>
7624 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7625 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7626 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7627 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7628 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7629
7630user <user>
7631 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7632 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7633 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7634 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7635 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7636
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007637verify [none|optional|required]
7638 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7639 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7640 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7641 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7642 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007643 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7644 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7645 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7646 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007647
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020076485.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007649------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007651The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7652which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7653arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7654settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7655after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7656Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7657address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007659 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007660 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007662The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007663
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007664addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007665 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7666 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7667 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7668 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7669 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007670
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007671 Supported in default-server: No
7672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007673backup
7674 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7675 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7676 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7677 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7678 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7679 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007680
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007681 Supported in default-server: No
7682
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007683ca-file <cafile>
7684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7685 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7686 server's certificate.
7687
7688 Supported in default-server: No
7689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007690check
7691 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007692 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7693 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7694 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7695 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7696 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7697 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7698 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09007699 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the
7700 "httpchk", "lb-agent-chk", "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and
7701 "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and parameters for
7702 more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007703
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007704 Supported in default-server: No
7705
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007706check-send-proxy
7707 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7708 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7709 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7710 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7711 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7712 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7713 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7714
7715 Supported in default-server: No
7716
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007717check-ssl
7718 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7719 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7720 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7721 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7722 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7723 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7724 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7725 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7726 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7727
7728 Supported in default-server: No
7729
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007730ciphers <ciphers>
7731 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7732 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7733 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7734 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7735 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7736 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7737 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7738 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7739
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007740 Supported in default-server: No
7741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007742cookie <value>
7743 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7744 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7745 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7746 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7747 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7748 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7749 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7750
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007751 Supported in default-server: No
7752
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007753crl-file <crlfile>
7754 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7755 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7756 to verify server's certificate.
7757
7758 Supported in default-server: No
7759
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007760crt <cert>
7761 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7762 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7763 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7764 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7765 certificate request.
7766
7767 Supported in default-server: No
7768
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007769disabled
7770 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7771 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7772 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7773 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7774 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7775
7776 Supported in default-server: No
7777
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007778error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007779 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7780 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7781 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007783 Supported in default-server: Yes
7784
7785 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007787fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007788 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7789 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7790 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007792 Supported in default-server: Yes
7793
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007794force-sslv3
7795 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7796 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7797 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7798
7799 Supported in default-server: No
7800
7801force-tlsv10
7802 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7803 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7804
7805 Supported in default-server: No
7806
7807force-tlsv11
7808 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7809 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7810
7811 Supported in default-server: No
7812
7813force-tlsv12
7814 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7815 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7816
7817 Supported in default-server: No
7818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007819id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007820 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7821 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7822 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007823
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007824 Supported in default-server: No
7825
7826inter <delay>
7827fastinter <delay>
7828downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007829 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7830 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7831 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7832 between checks depending on the server state :
7833
7834 Server state | Interval used
7835 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7836 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7837 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7838 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7839 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7840 or yet unchecked. |
7841 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7842 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7843 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007845 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7846 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7847 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7848 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7849 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7850 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7851 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7852 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7853 servers.
7854
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007855 Supported in default-server: Yes
7856
7857maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007858 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7859 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7860 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7861 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7862 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7863 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7864 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7865 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007867 Supported in default-server: Yes
7868
7869maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007870 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7871 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7872 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7873 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7874 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7875 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7876 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7877
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007878 Supported in default-server: Yes
7879
7880minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007881 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7882 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7883 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7884 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7885 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7886 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007887 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007888 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007889
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007890 Supported in default-server: Yes
7891
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007892no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007893 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7894 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007895 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007896
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007897 Supported in default-server: No
7898
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007899no-tls-tickets
7900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7901 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7902 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7903 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7904
7905 Supported in default-server: No
7906
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007907no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007908 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007909 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7910 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007911 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7912 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007913
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007914 Supported in default-server: No
7915
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007916no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007917 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007918 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7919 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007920 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7921 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007922
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007923 Supported in default-server: No
7924
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007925no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007926 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007927 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7928 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007929 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7930 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007931
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007932 Supported in default-server: No
7933
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007934non-stick
7935 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7936 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7937 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7938
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007939 Supported in default-server: No
7940
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007941observe <mode>
7942 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7943 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7944 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7945 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7946 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7947 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007948 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007950 Supported in default-server: No
7951
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007952 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007954on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007955 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7956 Currently, four modes are available:
7957 - fastinter: force fastinter
7958 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7959 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7960 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7961 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007963 Supported in default-server: Yes
7964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007965 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7966
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007967on-marked-down <action>
7968 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7969 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007970 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7971 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7972 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7973 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7974 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7975 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7976 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7977 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007978
7979 Actions are disabled by default
7980
7981 Supported in default-server: Yes
7982
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007983on-marked-up <action>
7984 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7985 Currently one action is available:
7986 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7987 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7988 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7989 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7990 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7991 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7992 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7993 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7994
7995 Actions are disabled by default
7996
7997 Supported in default-server: Yes
7998
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007999port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008000 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8001 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8002 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8003 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8004 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8005 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8006
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008007 Supported in default-server: Yes
8008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008009redir <prefix>
8010 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8011 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8012 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8013 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8014 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8015 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8016 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8017 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008018 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008019 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8020 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8021 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8022 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8023 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8024
8025 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8026
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008027 Supported in default-server: No
8028
8029rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008030 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8031 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8032 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8033
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008034 Supported in default-server: Yes
8035
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008036send-proxy
8037 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8038 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8039 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8040 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8041 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8042 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8043 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8044 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8045 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008046 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8047 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8048 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8049 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8050 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008051
8052 Supported in default-server: No
8053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008054slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008055 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8056 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8057 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8058 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8059 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8060 parameters :
8061
8062 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8063 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8064
8065 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8066 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8067 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8068 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8069
8070 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8071 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8072 seen as failed.
8073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008074 Supported in default-server: Yes
8075
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008076source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008077source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008078source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008079 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8080 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8081 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8082 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8083
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008084 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8085 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8086 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8087 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8088 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8089 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8090 server.
8091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008092 Supported in default-server: No
8093
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008094ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008095 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8096 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8097 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8098 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8099 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8100 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
8101 See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008102
8103 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008105track [<proxy>/]<server>
8106 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8107 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8108 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8109 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8110 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8111
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008112 Supported in default-server: No
8113
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008114verify [none|required]
8115 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8116 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
8117 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
8118 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008119 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8120 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8121 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008122
8123 Supported in default-server: No
8124
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008125verifyhost <hostname>
8126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8127 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8128 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8129 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8130 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8131 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8132
8133 Supported in default-server: No
8134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008135weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008136 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8137 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8138 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008139 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8140 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8141 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8142 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8143 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8144 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008145
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008146 Supported in default-server: Yes
8147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008148
81496. HTTP header manipulation
8150---------------------------
8151
8152In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8153response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8154request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8155which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
8156against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
8157to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
8158passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
8159headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
8160never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
8161
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008162There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
8163(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
8164rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
8165messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
8166in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008167happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008168add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
8169normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
8170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008171This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8172in section 4.2 :
8173
8174 - reqadd <string>
8175 - reqallow <search>
8176 - reqiallow <search>
8177 - reqdel <search>
8178 - reqidel <search>
8179 - reqdeny <search>
8180 - reqideny <search>
8181 - reqpass <search>
8182 - reqipass <search>
8183 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8184 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8185 - reqtarpit <search>
8186 - reqitarpit <search>
8187 - rspadd <string>
8188 - rspdel <search>
8189 - rspidel <search>
8190 - rspdeny <search>
8191 - rspideny <search>
8192 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8193 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8194
8195With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8196is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8197parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8198prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8199Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8200
8201 \t for a tab
8202 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8203 \n for a new line (LF)
8204 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8205 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8206 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8207 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8208 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8209
8210The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8211portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8212above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8213regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
82149 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8215is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8216
8217The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8218after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8219
8220Notes related to these keywords :
8221---------------------------------
8222 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8223 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8224 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8225
8226 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8227 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8228 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8229
8230 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8231 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8232 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8233 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8234 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8235
8236 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8237 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8238 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8239 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8240 useless headers before adding new ones.
8241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008242 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008243 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8244
8245 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8246 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8247 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8248
8249 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8250 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008251 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008252
8253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020082547. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8255----------------------------------
8256
8257Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8258client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8259The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8260these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8261but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8262data called patterns.
8263
8264
82657.1. ACL basics
8266---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008267
8268The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8269content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8270from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8271simple :
8272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008273 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
8274 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8275 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008277The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8278adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008279
8280In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008282 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008283
8284This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8285Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8286and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
8287an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
8288of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
8289
8290ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8291'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8292which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8293
8294There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8295performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008297The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8298specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8299this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
8300methods of a same sample fetch method.
8301
8302Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8303 - boolean
8304 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8305 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8306 - string
8307 - data block
8308
8309The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8310 - boolean
8311 - integer or integer range
8312 - IP address / network
8313 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8314 - regular expression
8315 - hex block
8316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008317The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8318
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008319 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8320 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008321 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008322 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008324The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8325read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8326if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8327lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8328will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8329beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8330a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8331lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8332exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8333
8334Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8335loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8336
8337 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8338
8339In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8340the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8341case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8342as well.
8343
8344The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8345sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8346do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8347methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8348is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8349obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8350followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8351default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8352that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8353string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8354
8355There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8356sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8357be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008358
8359 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8360 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008361 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8362 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8363 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8364 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008365
8366 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8367 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008368 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008369
8370 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008371 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008372
8373 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008374 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008375
8376 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8377 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8378
8379 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8380 binary or string samples.
8381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008382 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8383 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008385 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8386 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8387 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008389 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8390 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008392 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8393 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008395 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8396 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008398 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8399 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008400 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008402 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8403 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8404 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008405
8406For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8407request, it is possible to do :
8408
8409 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
8410
8411In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
8412buffer, one would use the following acl :
8413
8414 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
8415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008416All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
8417criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
8418method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
8419to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
8420criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
8421the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008423If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
8424the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
8425example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008427 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
8428 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
8429 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
8430 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008431
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008433The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample fetch types
8434and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
8435combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
8436the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008438 +-------------------------------------------------+
8439 | Input sample type |
8440 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8441 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
8442 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8443 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
8444 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8445 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | | |
8446 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8447 | integer (value) | int | *int | | | |
8448 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8449 | integer (length) | | | | len | len |
8450 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8451 | IP address | | | *ip | | |
8452 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8453 | exact string | | | | str | str |
8454 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8455 | prefix | | | | beg | beg |
8456 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8457 | suffix | | | | end | end |
8458 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8459 | substring | | | | sub | sub |
8460 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8461 | subdir | | | | dir | dir |
8462 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8463 | domain | | | | dom | dom |
8464 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8465 | regex | | | | reg | reg |
8466 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8467 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
8468 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008469
8470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020084717.1.1. Matching booleans
8472------------------------
8473
8474In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
8475Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
8476When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
8477that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
8478
8479Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
8480return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
8481"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
8482
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020084847.1.2. Matching integers
8485------------------------
8486
8487Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
8488enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
8489to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
8490
8491Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
8492matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
8493lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008494
8495For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8496unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8497representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8498
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008499As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8500two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8501instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8502ranges and operators.
8503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008504For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008505operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8506Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8507of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008508
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008509Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008510
8511 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8512 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8513 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8514 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8515 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008517For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008518
8519 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8520
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008521This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8522
8523 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8524
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085267.1.3. Matching strings
8527-----------------------
8528
8529String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
8530different forms :
8531
8532 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
8533 patterns ;
8534
8535 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
8536 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
8537
8538 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
8539 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8540
8541 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
8542 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8543
8544 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8545 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
8546 matches.
8547
8548 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8549 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
8550 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008551
8552String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8553exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8554characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8555string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8556to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008557before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008558
8559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085607.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8561---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008562
8563Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8564they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8565possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8566passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8567the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008568the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8569match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008570
8571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085727.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
8573-------------------------------------
8574
8575It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
8576not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
8577a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
8578to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
8579digits may be used upper or lower case.
8580
8581Example :
8582 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
8583 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
8584
8585
85867.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
8587---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008588
8589IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8590netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8591within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008592host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008593difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8594at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8595does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8596parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008597
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008598IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8599Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8600trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8601IPv6 patterns.
8602
8603HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
8604following situations :
8605 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
8606 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
8607 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
8608 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
8609 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
8610 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
8611 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
8612 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
8613 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
8614 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
8615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008616
86177.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
8618----------------------------------
8619
8620Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8621combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
8622
8623 - AND (implicit)
8624 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8625 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008627A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008629 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008631Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8632indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008634For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8635"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8636requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8637is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
8638
8639 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8640 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8641 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8642 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
8643
8644To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8645and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
8646
8647 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8648 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8649 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8650 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
8651
8652 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8653 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8654 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8655 use_backend www if host_www
8656
8657It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8658expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8659be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8660the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
8661
8662 The following rule :
8663
8664 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8665 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8666
8667 Can also be written that way :
8668
8669 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8670
8671It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8672to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8673simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8674sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8675good use is the following :
8676
8677 With named ACLs :
8678
8679 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8680 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8681 monitor fail if site_dead
8682
8683 With anonymous ACLs :
8684
8685 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8686
8687See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
8688
8689
86907.3. Fetching samples
8691---------------------
8692
8693Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
8694against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
8695sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
8696ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
8697of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
8698available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
8699
8700This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
8701Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
8702compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
8703deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
8704
8705The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
8706matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
8707method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
8708indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
8709
8710As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
8711when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
8712mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
8713the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
8714ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
8715
8716Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
8717multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
8718when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
8719incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
8720are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
8721is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
8722all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
8723
8724Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
8725 - name
8726 - name(arg1)
8727 - name(arg1,arg2)
8728
8729At the moment, the stickiness features are the most advanced users of the
8730sample fetch system. The "stick on", and "stick store-request" directives
8731support sample fetch rules which allow a list of transformations to be applied
8732on top of the fetched sample, and the finaly result is automatically converted
8733to the type of the table. These transformations are enumerated as a series
Willy Tarreau833cc792013-07-24 15:34:19 +02008734of specific keywords after the sample fetch method. These keywords may equally
8735be appended immediately after the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a
8736comma. These keywords can also support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which
8737must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008739The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008741 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
8742 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
8743 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008745 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
8746 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
8747 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008749 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
8750 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
8751 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8752 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8753 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8754
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02008755 http_date([<offset>])
8756 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
8757 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
8758 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
8759 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
8760 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
8761 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
8762 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
8763 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008764
87657.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
8766--------------------------------------------
8767
8768A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
8769not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
8770"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
8771The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
8772
8773always_false : boolean
8774 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
8775 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8776
8777always_true : boolean
8778 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
8779 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8780
8781avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008782 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008783 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
8784 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
8785 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
8786 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
8787 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
8788 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
8789 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
8790 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
8791 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
8792 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
8793 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
8794 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
8795 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01008796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008797be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008798 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
8799 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
8800 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8801 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
8802 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008804be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
8805 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8806 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
8807 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
8808 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
8809 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
8810 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008811
8812 Example :
8813 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
8814 backend dynamic
8815 mode http
8816 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
8817 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008819connslots([<backend>]) : integer
8820 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
8821 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
8822 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
8823 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05008824
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008825 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008826 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008827 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
8828
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008829 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
8830 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008831
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008832 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008833 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008834 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008835 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
8836 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008837 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008838 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008839
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008840 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
8841 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008842 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008843 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008844
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02008845date([<offset>]) : integer
8846 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
8847 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
8848 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
8849 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02008850 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
8851
8852 Example :
8853
8854 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
8855 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02008856
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02008857env(<name>) : string
8858 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
8859 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
8860 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
8861 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
8862 certain way.
8863
8864 Examples :
8865 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
8866 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
8867
8868 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
8869 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
8870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008871fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
8872 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008873 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
8874 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008875 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
8876 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
8877 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
8878 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
8879 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008881fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
8882 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8883 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
8884 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
8885 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
8886 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
8887 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
8888 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
8889 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008890
8891 Example :
8892 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8893 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8894 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8895 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8896 frontend mail
8897 bind :25
8898 mode tcp
8899 maxconn 100
8900 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8901 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8902 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8903 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008905nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
8906 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
8907 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
8908 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008909 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8910 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8911 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008913queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008914 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8915 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8916 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008917 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
8918 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
8919 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
8920 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
8921 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
8922
8923srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
8924 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
8925 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
8926 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
8927 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
8928 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
8929 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
8930 methods.
8931
8932srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
8933 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8934 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8935 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
8936 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
8937 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
8938 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
8939 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8940
8941srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
8942 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8943 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
8944 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
8945 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
8946 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
8947 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
8948 overloading servers).
8949
8950 Example :
8951 # Redirect to a separate back
8952 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
8953 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
8954 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
8955
8956table_avl([<table>]) : integer
8957 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8958 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8959
8960table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
8961 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8962 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8963 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8964
8965
89667.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
8967----------------------------------
8968
8969The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
8970closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
8971methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
8972sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
8973TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02008974the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
8975counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
8976"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02008977argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
8978the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
8979this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008980
8981be_id : integer
8982 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
8983 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
8984
8985dst : ip
8986 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
8987 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
8988 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8989 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
8990 RFC 4291.
8991
8992dst_conn : integer
8993 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
8994 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
8995 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
8996 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
8997 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
8998 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
8999 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9000 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009002dst_port : integer
9003 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9004 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9005 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9006 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9007 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9008 an HTTP header.
9009
9010fe_id : integer
9011 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9012 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9013 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9014
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009015sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9016sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9017sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9018sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009019 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9020 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9021 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9022
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009023sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9024sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9025sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9026sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009027 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9028 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9029 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9030
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009031sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9032sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9033sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9034sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009035 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9036 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009037 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9038 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9039 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009040
9041 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9042 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009043 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9044 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9045 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009046 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9047 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9048
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009049sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9050sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9051sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9052sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009053 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9054 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9055
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009056sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9057sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9058sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9059sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009060 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9061 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9062 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9063
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009064sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9065sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9066sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9067sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009068 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9069 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9070 See also src_conn_rate.
9071
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009072sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9073sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9074sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9075sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009076 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009077 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009078
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009079sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9080sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9081sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9082sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009083 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9084 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9085 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009086 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9087 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9088 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009089
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009090sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9091sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9092sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9093sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009094 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9095 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9096 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9097
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009098sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9099sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9100sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9101sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009102 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9103 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9104 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9105 src_http_err_rate.
9106
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009107sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9108sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9109sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9110sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009111 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9112 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9113 src_http_req_cnt.
9114
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009115sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9116sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9117sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9118sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009119 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9120 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9121 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9122 src_http_req_rate.
9123
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009124sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9125sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9126sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9127sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009128 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009129 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9130 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9131 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9132 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009133
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009134 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9135 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009136 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9137
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009138sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9139sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9140sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9141sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009142 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9143 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9144 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9145 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9146
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009147sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9148sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9149sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9150sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009151 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9152 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9153 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9154 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9155
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009156sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9157sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9158sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9159sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009160 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9161 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9162 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9163 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009164 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009165 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9166
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009167sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9168sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9169sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9170sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009171 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9172 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9173 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9174 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9175 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009176 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009177
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009178sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9179sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9180sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9181sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009182 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9183 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9184 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9185
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009186sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9187sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9188sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9189sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009190 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9191 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009192 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009193 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9194 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009195 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9196 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9197 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009199so_id : integer
9200 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9201 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9202 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009204src : ip
9205 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9206 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9207 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9208 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9209 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9210 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9211 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009213src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9214 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9215 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9216 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009217 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009219src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9220 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9221 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009222 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009223 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009225src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9226 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9227 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9228 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9229 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9230 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9231 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009232
9233 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9234 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9235 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9236 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009237 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009238 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9239 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009241src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009242 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009243 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009244 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009245 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009247src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009248 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009249 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9250 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009251 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009253src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9254 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9255 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9256 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009257 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009259src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009260 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009261 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009262 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009263 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009265src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009266 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009267 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009268 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9269 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009270 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9271 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9272 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009274src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9275 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9276 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009277 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009278 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009279 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009281src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9282 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9283 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9284 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9285 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009286 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009288src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9289 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9290 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9291 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009292 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009294src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9295 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9296 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9297 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009298 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009299 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009301src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9302 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9303 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9304 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009305 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009306 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9307 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009308
9309 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009310 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009311 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009313src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9314 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9315 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9316 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9317 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009318 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
9319 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009321src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9322 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9323 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009324 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9325 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009326 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009328src_port : integer
9329 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9330 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9331 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9332 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009334src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9335 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009336 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9337 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9338 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009339 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009341src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9342 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
9343 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9344 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9345 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009346 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009348src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9349 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
9350 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
9351 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
9352 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
9353 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
9354 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
9355 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
9356 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009357
9358 Example :
9359 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
9360 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
9361 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
9362 listen ssh
9363 bind :22
9364 mode tcp
9365 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009366 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009367 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009368 server local 127.0.0.1:22
9369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009370srv_id : integer
9371 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
9372 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
9373 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02009374
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01009375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093767.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
9377----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02009378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009379The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
9380closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
9381when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
9382usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
9383future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009385ssl_c_ca_err : integer
9386 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9387 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
9388 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
9389 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
9390 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009392ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
9393 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9394 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
9395 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
9396 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009398ssl_c_err : integer
9399 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9400 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
9401 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
9402 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
9403 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009405ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9406 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9407 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9408 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9409 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9410 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9411 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9412 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9413 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009415 ACL derivatives :
9416 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009418ssl_c_key_alg : string
9419 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9420 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9421 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009423 ACL derivatives :
9424 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009426ssl_c_notafter : string
9427 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
9428 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9429 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009431 ACL derivatives :
9432 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009434ssl_c_notbefore : string
9435 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
9436 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9437 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009439 ACL derivatives :
9440 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009442ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9443 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9444 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9445 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9446 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9447 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9448 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9449 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9450 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009452 ACL derivatives :
9453 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009455ssl_c_serial : binary
9456 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
9457 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9458 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009460 ACL derivatives :
9461 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009463ssl_c_sha1 : binary
9464 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
9465 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
9466 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009468ssl_c_sig_alg : string
9469 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9470 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9471 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009473 ACL derivatives :
9474 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
9475
9476ssl_c_used : boolean
9477 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
9478 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009480ssl_c_verify : integer
9481 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
9482 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
9483 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
9484 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009486ssl_c_version : integer
9487 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
9488 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009490ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9491 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9492 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9493 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9494 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009495 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009496 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9497 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9498 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009500 ACL derivatives :
9501 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009503ssl_f_key_alg : string
9504 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9505 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
9506 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009508 ACL derivatives :
9509 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009511ssl_f_notafter : string
9512 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9513 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9514 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009516 ACL derivatives :
9517 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009519ssl_f_notbefore : string
9520 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9521 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9522 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009524 ACL derivatives :
9525 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009527ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9528 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9529 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9530 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9531 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9532 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9533 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9534 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9535 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009537 ACL derivatives :
9538 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009540ssl_f_serial : binary
9541 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9542 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9543 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009545 ACL derivatives :
9546 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009548ssl_f_sig_alg : string
9549 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9550 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9551 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009553 ACL derivatives :
9554 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009556ssl_f_version : integer
9557 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9558 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9559
9560ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009561 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9562 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
9563 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
9564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009565 Example :
9566 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
9567 listen http-https
9568 bind :80
9569 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
9570 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
9571
9572ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
9573 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
9574 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9575
9576ssl_fc_alpn : string
9577 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
9578 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
9579 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
9580 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
9581 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
9582 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
9583 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
9584 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
9585 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
9586
9587 ACL derivatives :
9588 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009590ssl_fc_cipher : string
9591 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
9592 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009594 ACL derivatives :
9595 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009597ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009598 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
9599 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009600 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
9601 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
9602 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
9603 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009605ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
9606 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009607 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
9608 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
9609 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9610 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009612ssl_fc_npn : string
9613 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
9614 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
9615 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
9616 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9617 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
9618 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
9619 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
9620 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009622 ACL derivatives :
9623 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009625ssl_fc_protocol : string
9626 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
9627 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009629 ACL derivatives :
9630 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
9631
9632ssl_fc_session_id : binary
9633 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
9634 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
9635 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
9636 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009638ssl_fc_sni : string
9639 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
9640 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9641 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
9642 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
9643 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
9644
9645 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
9646 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
9647 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02009648 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
9649 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009651 ACL derivatives :
9652 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
9653 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
9654 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009656ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
9657 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
9658 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009659
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096617.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
9662------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009664Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
9665sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
9666only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
9667For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
9668be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
9669can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
9670sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
9671for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
9672content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009674payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
9675 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
9676 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
9677 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009679payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
9680 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
9681 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
9682 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009684req.len : integer
9685req_len : integer (deprecated)
9686 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
9687 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
9688 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
9689 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
9690 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
9691 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
9692 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
9693 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009695req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
9696 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +02009697 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
9698 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
9699 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
9700 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009702 ACL alternatives :
9703 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009705req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
9706 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9707 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9708 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
9709 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009711 ACL alternatives :
9712 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009714 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009716req.proto_http : boolean
9717req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
9718 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
9719 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
9720 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
9721 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
9722 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
9723 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
9724 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009726 Example:
9727 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9728 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
9729 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009730 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009732req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
9733rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
9734 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
9735 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
9736 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
9737 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
9738 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
9739 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
9740 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009742 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
9743 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
9744 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9745 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
9746 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
9747 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009749 ACL derivatives :
9750 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009752 Example :
9753 listen tse-farm
9754 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9755 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9756 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9757 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9758 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9759 persist rdp-cookie
9760 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9761 # This is only useful makes sense if
9762 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9763 stick-table type string size 204800
9764 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9765 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9766 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009768 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
9769 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009771req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
9772rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
9773 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
9774 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
9775 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
9776 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009778 ACL derivatives :
9779 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009781req.ssl_hello_type : integer
9782req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
9783 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
9784 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
9785 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
9786 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
9787 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
9788 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
9789 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009791req.ssl_sni : string
9792req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
9793 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
9794 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
9795 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
9796 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
9797 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
9798 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
9799 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
9800 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
9801 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
9802 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
9803 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
9804 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009806 ACL derivatives :
9807 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009809 Examples :
9810 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
9811 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9812 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
9813 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
9814 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009816res.ssl_hello_type : integer
9817rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
9818 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
9819 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
9820 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
9821 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
9822 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
9823 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
9824 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02009825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009826req.ssl_ver : integer
9827req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
9828 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
9829 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
9830 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
9831 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
9832 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
9833 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
9834 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
9835 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
9836 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009838 ACL derivatives :
9839 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009840
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +02009841res.len : integer
9842 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
9843 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
9844 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
9845 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
9846 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
9847 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
9848 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
9849 content inspection.
9850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009851res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
9852 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +02009853 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
9854 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
9855 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
9856 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009858res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
9859 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9860 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9861 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
9862 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009864 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009866wait_end : boolean
9867 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
9868 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
9869 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
9870 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
9871 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
9872 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
9873 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
9874 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009876 Examples :
9877 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
9878 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
9879 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009881 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
9882 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
9883 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
9884 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
9885 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
9886 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
9887 tcp-request content reject
9888
9889
98907.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
9891--------------------------------------
9892
9893It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
9894This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
9895data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
9896its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
9897HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
9898content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
9899to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
9900more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
9901response are indexed.
9902
9903base : string
9904 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
9905 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
9906 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
9907 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
9908 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9909 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
9910 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
9911 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
9912
9913 ACL derivatives :
9914 base : exact string match
9915 base_beg : prefix match
9916 base_dir : subdir match
9917 base_dom : domain match
9918 base_end : suffix match
9919 base_len : length match
9920 base_reg : regex match
9921 base_sub : substring match
9922
9923base32 : integer
9924 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
9925 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
9926 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
9927 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
9928
9929base32+src : binary
9930 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
9931 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
9932 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
9933 per-URL counters.
9934
9935req.cook([<name>]) : string
9936cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
9937 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
9938 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
9939 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
9940 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
9941 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
9942 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
9943 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
9944 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9945
9946 ACL derivatives :
9947 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
9948 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
9949 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
9950 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
9951 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
9952 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
9953 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
9954 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009956req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
9957cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
9958 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
9959 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009961req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
9962cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
9963 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
9964 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
9965 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
9966 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009968cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
9969 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
9970 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
9971 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
9972 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
9973 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9974 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
9975 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
9976 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
9977 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
9978 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009980hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
9981 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
9982 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
9983 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
9984 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
9985 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009987req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
9988 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
9989 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
9990 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
9991 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
9992 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
9993 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
9994 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
9995 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009997req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
9998 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
9999 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10000 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10001 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010003req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10004 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10005 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10006 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10007 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10008 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10009 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10010 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10011 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10012 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10013 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10014 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010016 ACL derivatives :
10017 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10018 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10019 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10020 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10021 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10022 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10023 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10024 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10025
10026req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10027hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10028 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10029 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10030 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10031 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10032 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10033 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10034 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10035 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10036 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10037
10038req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10039hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10040 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10041 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10042 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10043 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10044 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10045 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10046 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10047 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10048
10049req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10050hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10051 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10052 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10053 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10054 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10055 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10056 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10057 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10058
10059http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10060 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10061 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10062 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10063 basic auth is supported.
10064
10065http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
10066 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10067 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
10068 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
10069 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10070 basic auth is supported.
10071
10072 ACL derivatives :
10073 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
10074
10075http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010076 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10077 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010078 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10079 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010081method : integer + string
10082 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10083 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10084 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10085 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10086 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10087 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10088 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010090 ACL derivatives :
10091 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010093 Example :
10094 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10095 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10096 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010098path : string
10099 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10100 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10101 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10102 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10103 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10104 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10105 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010107 ACL derivatives :
10108 path : exact string match
10109 path_beg : prefix match
10110 path_dir : subdir match
10111 path_dom : domain match
10112 path_end : suffix match
10113 path_len : length match
10114 path_reg : regex match
10115 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010117req.ver : string
10118req_ver : string (deprecated)
10119 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10120 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10121 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010123 ACL derivatives :
10124 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010126res.comp : boolean
10127 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10128 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10129 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010131res.comp_algo : string
10132 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10133 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10134 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010136res.cook([<name>]) : string
10137scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10138 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10139 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10140 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010142 ACL derivatives :
10143 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010145res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10146scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10147 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10148 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10149 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010151res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10152scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10153 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10154 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10155 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010157res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10158 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10159 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10160 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10161 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10162 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10163 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10164 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10165 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10166 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010168res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10169 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10170 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10171 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10172 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10173 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010175res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10176shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10177 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10178 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10179 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10180 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10181 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10182 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10183 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10184 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010186 ACL derivatives :
10187 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10188 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10189 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10190 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10191 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10192 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10193 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10194 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10195
10196res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10197shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10198 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10199 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10200 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10201 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10202 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010204res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10205shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10206 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10207 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10208 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10209 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10210 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10211 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010213res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10214shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10215 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10216 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10217 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10218 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10219 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10220 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010222res.ver : string
10223resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10224 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10225 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010227 ACL derivatives :
10228 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010230set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10231 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10232 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10233 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10234 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010236 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10237 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010239 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010241status : integer
10242 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10243 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10244 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010246url : string
10247 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10248 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10249 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10250 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10251 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10252 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10253 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010255 ACL derivatives :
10256 url : exact string match
10257 url_beg : prefix match
10258 url_dir : subdir match
10259 url_dom : domain match
10260 url_end : suffix match
10261 url_len : length match
10262 url_reg : regex match
10263 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010265url_ip : ip
10266 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10267 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10268 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10269 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10270 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10271 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10272 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010274url_port : integer
10275 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10276 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10277 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10278 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010280urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10281url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10282 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10283 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10284 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10285 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10286 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10287 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10288 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10289 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10290 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010292 ACL derivatives :
10293 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10294 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10295 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10296 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10297 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10298 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10299 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10300 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010301
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010303 Example :
10304 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10305 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10306 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10307 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010309urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10310 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10311 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10312 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010313
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103157.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010316---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010317
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010318Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
10319every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010320order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010322ACL name Equivalent to Usage
10323---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010324FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010325HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010326HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
10327HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010328HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
10329HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
10330HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
10331HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
10332LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010333METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
10334METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
10335METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
10336METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
10337METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
10338METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010339RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010340REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010341TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010342WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
10343---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010344
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010345
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103468. Logging
10347----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010348
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010349One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
10350provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
10351very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
10352provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
10353state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010354to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010355headers.
10356
10357In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
10358about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
10359send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
10360
10361 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
10362 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
10363 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
10364 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
10365 at the termination.
10366
10367The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
10368allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
10369as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
10370while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
10371real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
10372delay.
10373
10374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103758.1. Log levels
10376---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010377
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010378TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010379source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010380HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
10381in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
10382track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
10383syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
10384about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010385
10386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103878.2. Log formats
10388----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010389
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010390HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010391and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
10392slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
10393options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010394
10395 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
10396 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
10397 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
10398 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
10399 extents.
10400
10401 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
10402 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
10403 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
10404 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
10405 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
10406
10407 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
10408 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
10409 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
10410 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
10411 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
10412
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010413 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
10414 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
10415 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
10416 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
10417
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010418 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
10419
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010420Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
10421specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
10422field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
10423servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
10424always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
10425identifier.
10426
10427Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
10428 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
10429 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
10430 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
10431 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
10432
10433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104348.2.1. Default log format
10435-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010436
10437This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
10438as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
10439format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
10440
10441 Example :
10442 listen www
10443 mode http
10444 log global
10445 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10446
10447 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
10448 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
10449 (www/HTTP)
10450
10451 Field Format Extract from the example above
10452 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
10453 2 'Connect from' Connect from
10454 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
10455 4 'to' to
10456 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
10457 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
10458
10459Detailed fields description :
10460 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
10461 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
10462 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
10463 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
10464 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10465 and processed the connection.
10466 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
10467
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010468In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
10469"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
10470connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
10471
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010472It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
10473will eventually disappear.
10474
10475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104768.2.2. TCP log format
10477---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010478
10479The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
10480is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
10481information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
10482counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
10483emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
10484environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
10485the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
10486sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010487specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
10488not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
10489fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
10490marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010491
10492 Example :
10493 frontend fnt
10494 mode tcp
10495 option tcplog
10496 log global
10497 default_backend bck
10498
10499 backend bck
10500 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10501
10502 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
10503 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
10504 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
10505
10506 Field Format Extract from the example above
10507 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
10508 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
10509 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
10510 4 frontend_name fnt
10511 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
10512 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
10513 7 bytes_read* 212
10514 8 termination_state --
10515 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
10516 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10517
10518Detailed fields description :
10519 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010520 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10521 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10522 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10523 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10524 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010525
10526 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010527 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10528 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10529 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010530
10531 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
10532 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
10533 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
10534 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
10535
10536 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10537 and processed the connection.
10538
10539 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10540 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10541 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
10542 applications.
10543
10544 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10545 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10546 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10547 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
10548 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
10549
10550 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10551 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10552 See "Timers" below for more details.
10553
10554 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10555 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10556 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
10557 "Timers" below for more details.
10558
10559 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10560 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10561 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10562 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10563 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10564 details.
10565
10566 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
10567 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
10568 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
10569 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
10570 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
10571
10572 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10573 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10574 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
10575 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
10576 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
10577 for more details.
10578
10579 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010580 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010581 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
10582 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
10583 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010584 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010585
10586 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10587 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10588 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10589 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10590 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10591 caused by a denial of service attack.
10592
10593 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10594 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10595 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10596 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10597 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10598 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10599 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10600 denial of service attack.
10601
10602 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10603 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10604 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10605 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10606 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10607 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10608 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10609 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
10610 be processed than on other servers.
10611
10612 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10613 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10614 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10615 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10616 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10617 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10618 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10619 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10620 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10621 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10622 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10623 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10624 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10625
10626 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10627 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10628 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10629 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10630 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10631 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10632 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10633 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10634
10635 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10636 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10637 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10638 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10639 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10640 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10641 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10642 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10643 occurs.
10644
10645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106468.2.3. HTTP log format
10647----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010648
10649The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
10650is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
10651the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
10652are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
10653emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
10654generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
10655"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
10656which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010657frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
10658is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010659
10660Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
10661slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
10662with a star ('*') after the field name below.
10663
10664 Example :
10665 frontend http-in
10666 mode http
10667 option httplog
10668 log global
10669 default_backend bck
10670
10671 backend static
10672 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10673
10674 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10675 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10676 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010677 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010678
10679 Field Format Extract from the example above
10680 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
10681 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
10682 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
10683 4 frontend_name http-in
10684 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
10685 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
10686 7 status_code 200
10687 8 bytes_read* 2750
10688 9 captured_request_cookie -
10689 10 captured_response_cookie -
10690 11 termination_state ----
10691 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
10692 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10693 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
10694 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
10695 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010696
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010697
10698Detailed fields description :
10699 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010700 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10701 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10702 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10703 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10704 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010705
10706 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010707 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10708 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10709 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010710
10711 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
10712 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
10713 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
10714 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
10715 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
10716
10717 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10718 and processed the connection.
10719
10720 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10721 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10722 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
10723
10724 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10725 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10726 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10727 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
10728 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
10729 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
10730
10731 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
10732 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
10733 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
10734 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
10735 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
10736 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
10737
10738 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10739 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10740 See "Timers" below for more details.
10741
10742 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10743 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10744 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
10745 below for more details.
10746
10747 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
10748 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
10749 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
10750 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
10751 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
10752 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
10753 for more details.
10754
10755 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10756 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10757 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10758 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10759 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10760 details.
10761
10762 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
10763 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
10764 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
10765
10766 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
10767 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
10768 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
10769 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
10770 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
10771 overflowing.
10772
10773 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
10774 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
10775 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
10776 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
10777 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
10778 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
10779 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
10780 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10781
10782 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
10783 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
10784 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
10785 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
10786 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
10787 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
10788 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
10789 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10790
10791 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10792 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10793 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
10794 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
10795 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
10796 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
10797 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
10798
10799 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010800 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010801 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
10802 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
10803 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010804 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010805 system.
10806
10807 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10808 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10809 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10810 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10811 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10812 caused by a denial of service attack.
10813
10814 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10815 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10816 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10817 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10818 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10819 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10820 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10821 denial of service attack.
10822
10823 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10824 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10825 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10826 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10827 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10828 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10829 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10830 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10831 processed than on other servers.
10832
10833 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10834 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10835 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10836 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10837 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10838 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10839 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10840 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10841 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10842 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10843 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10844 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10845 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10846
10847 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10848 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10849 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10850 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10851 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10852 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10853 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10854 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10855
10856 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10857 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10858 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10859 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10860 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10861 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10862 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10863 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10864 occurs.
10865
10866 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10867 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10868 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10869 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10870 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10871 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10872 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10873 cookies" below for more details.
10874
10875 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10876 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10877 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10878 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10879 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10880 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10881 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10882 and cookies" below for more details.
10883
10884 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10885 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10886 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10887 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10888 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10889 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10890 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10891 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10892
10893
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200108948.2.4. Custom log format
10895------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010896
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010897The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010898mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010899
10900HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10901Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10902separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10903prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10904
10905Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10906variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10907string formats ("Q").
10908
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010909If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010910as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010911less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
10912the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
10913
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010914Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10915HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10916
10917Flags are :
10918 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010919 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010920
10921 Example:
10922
10923 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10924 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10925
10926At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10927
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010928 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
10929 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010930
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010931the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010932
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010933 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010934 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010935 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010936
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010937and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10938
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010939 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010940 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10941
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010942Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10943
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010944 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010945 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010946 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10947 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10948 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010949 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
10950 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
10951 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010952 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010953 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010954 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010955 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010956 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010957 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010958 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10959 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010960 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010961 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10962 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010963 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010964 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10965 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010966 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10967 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
10968 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010969 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010970 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
10971 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010972 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010973 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10974 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
10975 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010976 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010977 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10978 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10979 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10980 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010981 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010982 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010983 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010984 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010985 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010986 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010987 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
10988 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
10989 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010990 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010991 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10992 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010993 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010994 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010995 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010996 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010997
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010998 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010999
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011000
110018.2.5. Error log format
11002-----------------------
11003
11004When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11005protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11006By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11007"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11008will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11009logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11010
11011The format looks like this :
11012
11013 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11014 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11015 Connection error during SSL handshake
11016
11017 Field Format Extract from the example above
11018 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11019 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11020 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11021 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11022 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11023
11024These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11025failures.
11026
11027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110288.3. Advanced logging options
11029-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011030
11031Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11032just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11033options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11034for more information about their usage.
11035
11036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110378.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11038------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011039
11040It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11041haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11042commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11043monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11044ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11045
11046 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11047 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11048 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11049 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11050
11051 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11052 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11053 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
11054 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
11055 such as other load-balancers.
11056
11057 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11058 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11059 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11060
11061
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110628.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11063----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011064
11065The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11066what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11067or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11068"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11069just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11070log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11071after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11072is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11073with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11074with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11075
11076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110778.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11078------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011079
11080Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11081for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11082"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11083retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11084raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11085a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11086file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11087you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11088"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11089
11090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11092--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011093
11094Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11095multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11096them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11097"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11098logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11099error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11100and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11101too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11102useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11103alternative.
11104
11105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111068.4. Timing events
11107------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011108
11109Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11110reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11111the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11112frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11113mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11114
11115 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11116 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11117 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11118 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11119 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11120
11121 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11122 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11123 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11124 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11125 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11126
11127 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11128 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11129 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11130 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11131 connection never established.
11132
11133 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11134 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11135 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11136 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11137 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11138 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11139 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11140 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11141 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11142 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11143 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11144
11145 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11146 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11147 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11148 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11149 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11150
11151 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11152
11153 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11154 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11155 negative.
11156
11157These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11158protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11159that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011160due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011161close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11162session has been aborted on timeout.
11163
11164Most common cases :
11165
11166 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11167 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11168 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11169 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11170 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11171 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11172 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11173 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11174 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011175 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11176 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11177 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011178
11179 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11180 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11181 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11182 of ms on remote networks.
11183
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011184 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11185 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11186 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011187
11188 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11189 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11190 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11191 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11192 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11193 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11194 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11195 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11196 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11197 to the server until another one is released.
11198
11199Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11200
11201 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11202 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11203 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11204
11205 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11206 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11207 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11208
11209 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11210 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11211 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11212 flags.
11213
11214 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11215 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11216 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11217 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11218 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11219 the client connection was maintained open.
11220
11221 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11222 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11223 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11224 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11225
11226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112278.5. Session state at disconnection
11228-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011229
11230TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11231"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
112322-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11233each of which has a special meaning :
11234
11235 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11236 session to terminate :
11237
11238 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11239
11240 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11241 server explicitly refused it.
11242
11243 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11244 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11245 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11246 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011247 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11248
11249 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11250 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011251
11252 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11253 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11254 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11255 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11256 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11257
11258 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11259 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11260 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11261 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11262 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11263
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011264 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11265 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11266
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011267 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11268 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11269 backup connections when going up.
11270
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011271 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11272
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011273 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11274 send or receive data.
11275
11276 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11277 send or receive data.
11278
11279 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11280 with nothing left in the buffers.
11281
11282 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11283
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011284 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011285 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11286
11287 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11288 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11289 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11290 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11291 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11292
11293 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11294 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11295
11296 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11297 server (HTTP only).
11298
11299 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11300
11301 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11302 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11303 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11304
11305 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11306 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11307 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11308
11309 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11310
11311 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11312 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11313
11314 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11315 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
11316 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
11317
11318 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
11319 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020011320 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
11321 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011322
11323 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
11324 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
11325 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
11326 another server.
11327
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011328 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011329 server.
11330
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011331 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
11332 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
11333 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
11334 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11335
11336 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
11337 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
11338 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
11339 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11340
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020011341 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
11342 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
11343 "use-server" rule).
11344
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011345 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11346
11347 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
11348 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
11349
11350 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
11351
11352 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
11353 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
11354 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
11355
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011356 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
11357 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
11358 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
11359 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
11360 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
11361
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011362 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
11363
11364 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
11365 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
11366
11367 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
11368
11369 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11370
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011371The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
11372was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011373helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
11374starvation, attacks, etc...
11375
11376The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
11377alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
11378easier finding and understanding.
11379
11380 Flags Reason
11381
11382 -- Normal termination.
11383
11384 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
11385 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
11386 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
11387 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
11388
11389 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
11390 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
11391 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
11392 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
11393 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
11394 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011395
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011396 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11397 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011398 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011399
11400 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
11401 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
11402 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
11403
11404 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
11405 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
11406 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
11407 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
11408 the server takes too long to respond.
11409
11410 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
11411 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
11412 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
11413 long a time to respond.
11414
11415 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
11416 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
11417 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
11418 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
11419 and the client.
11420
11421 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
11422 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
11423 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
11424 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
11425 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
11426 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
11427
11428 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
11429 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011430 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
11431 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
11432 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
11433 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011434
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011435 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
11436 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
11437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011438 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011439 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
11440 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
11441 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
11442 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
11443 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
11444
11445 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
11446 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
11447 503 or 504 here.
11448
11449 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
11450 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
11451 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
11452 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
11453 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
11454
11455 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11456 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011457 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011458 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
11459 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
11460
11461 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
11462 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
11463 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
11464 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
11465 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
11466 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
11467 between haproxy and the server.
11468
11469 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
11470 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
11471 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
11472 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
11473 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
11474 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
11475 solution is to fix the application.
11476
11477 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
11478 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
11479 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
11480 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
11481 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
11482 external attacks.
11483
11484 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
11485 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011486 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011487 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
11488 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
11489
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011490 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
11491 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
11492 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020011493 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
11494 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011495
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011496 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
11497 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
11498 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
11499 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011500 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
11501 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
11502 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
11503 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
11504 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011505
11506 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
11507 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
11508 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
11509 returned an HTTP 403 error.
11510
11511 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
11512 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
11513 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
11514 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
11515
11516 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
11517 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
11518 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
11519 only be solved by proper system tuning.
11520
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011521The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
11522persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
11523important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
11524re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
11525
11526 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
11527
11528 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11529 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
11530 set on a GET request.
11531
11532 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
11533 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011534 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011535 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
11536
11537 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
11538 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
11539 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
11540
11541 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11542 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
11543 already got a cookie.
11544
11545 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11546 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
11547 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
11548 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
11549 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
11550
11551 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11552 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11553 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11554
11555 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
11556 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11557 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11558
11559 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
11560 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
11561
11562 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
11563 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
11564 then advertised in the response.
11565
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115678.6. Non-printable characters
11568-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011569
11570In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
11571consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
11572converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
11573prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
11574being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
11575escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
11576is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
11577'}' when logging headers.
11578
11579Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
11580issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
11581containing spaces is "User-Agent".
11582
11583Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
11584the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
11585performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
11586
11587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115888.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
11589---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011590
11591Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
11592achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011593section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011594cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
11595the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
11596the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011597locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011598not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
11599user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
11600a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
11601wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
11602
11603 Examples :
11604 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
11605 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
11606
11607 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
11608 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
11609
11610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
11612---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011613
11614Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
11615proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
11616the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
11617server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
11618
11619Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
11620response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011621section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011622
11623It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011624time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
11625appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011626are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
11627and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
11628follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
11629request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
11630in the logs.
11631
11632 Example :
11633 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
11634 listen proxy-out
11635 mode http
11636 option httplog
11637 option logasap
11638 log global
11639 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
11640
11641 # log the name of the virtual server
11642 capture request header Host len 20
11643
11644 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
11645 capture request header Content-Length len 10
11646
11647 # log the beginning of the referrer
11648 capture request header Referer len 20
11649
11650 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
11651 capture response header Server len 20
11652
11653 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
11654 capture response header Content-Length len 10
11655
11656 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
11657 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
11658
11659 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
11660 capture response header Via len 20
11661
11662 # log the URL location during a redirection
11663 capture response header Location len 20
11664
11665 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
11666 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
11667 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11668 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
11669 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
11670
11671 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11672 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11673 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11674 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011675 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011676
11677 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11678 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11679 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11680 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
11681 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011682 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011683
11684
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116858.9. Examples of logs
11686---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011687
11688These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
11689them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
11690reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
11691
11692 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
11693 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11694 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11695
11696 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
11697 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
11698
11699 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
11700 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
11701 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11702
11703 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
11704 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
11705
11706 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
11707 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11708 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
11709
11710 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011711 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011712 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
11713 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
11714
11715 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
11716 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
11717 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
11718
11719 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
11720 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011721 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011722 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
11723 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
11724 to return the 502 and not the server.
11725
11726 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011727 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011728
11729 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
11730 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
11731 Nothing was sent to any server.
11732
11733 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
11734 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
11735
11736 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
11737 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
11738 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
11739 send a 408 return code to the client.
11740
11741 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
11742 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
11743
11744 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
11745 5 seconds ("c----").
11746
11747 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
11748 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011749 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011750
11751 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011752 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011753 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
11754 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
11755 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
11756 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
11757 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011758
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117609. Statistics and monitoring
11761----------------------------
11762
11763It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
11764mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
11765CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
11766Unix socket.
11767
11768
117699.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011770---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011771
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010011772The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
11773page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
11774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011775 0. pxname: proxy name
11776 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
11777 for server)
11778 2. qcur: current queued requests
11779 3. qmax: max queued requests
11780 4. scur: current sessions
11781 5. smax: max sessions
11782 6. slim: sessions limit
11783 7. stot: total sessions
11784 8. bin: bytes in
11785 9. bout: bytes out
11786 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011787 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011788 12. ereq: request errors
11789 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011790 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011791 15. wretr: retries (warning)
11792 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010011793 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011794 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
11795 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
11796 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
11797 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
11798 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
11799 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
11800 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
11801 25. qlimit: queue limit
11802 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
11803 27. iid: unique proxy id
11804 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
11805 29. throttle: warm up status
11806 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
11807 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020011808 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020011809 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
11810 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
11811 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011812 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011813 UNK -> unknown
11814 INI -> initializing
11815 SOCKERR -> socket error
11816 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
11817 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
11818 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
11819 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
11820 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
11821 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11822 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11823 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
11824 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
11825 disable-on-404
11826 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11827 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11828 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011829 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
11830 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011831 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
11832 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
11833 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
11834 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
11835 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
11836 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011837 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
11838 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
11839 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
11840 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011841 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
11842 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010011843 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
11844 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
11845 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010011846 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011847
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118499.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011850-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011851
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020011852The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
11853necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
11854A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
11855issuing commands by hand :
11856
11857 global
11858 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
11859 stats timeout 2m
11860
11861It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
11862the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
11863never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
11864situations :
11865
11866 global
11867 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
11868 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
11869 stats timeout 2m
11870
11871To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
11872swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
11873to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
11874syntaxes we'll use are the following :
11875
11876 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
11877 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
11878
11879The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
11880script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
11881for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
11882
11883The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
11884that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
11885editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
11886(eg: watch a counter).
11887
11888The socket supports two operation modes :
11889 - interactive
11890 - non-interactive
11891
11892The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
11893this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
11894sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
11895mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
11896commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
11897example :
11898
11899 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
11900
11901The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
11902entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
11903for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
11904sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
11905"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
11906after processing the last command of the same line.
11907
11908For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
11909"prompt" command :
11910
11911 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
11912 prompt
11913 > show info
11914 ...
11915 >
11916
11917Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
11918delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
11919that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
11920parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011921
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011922It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
11923on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
11924own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011925
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020011926The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
11927If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
11928all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
11929it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
11930
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011931clear counters
11932 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
11933 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
11934 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
11935 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
11936 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11937
11938clear counters all
11939 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11940 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11941 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11942
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011943clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11944 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11945
11946 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11947 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11948 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11949 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11950 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11951 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11952
11953 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11954
11955 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11956 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11957 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11958 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11959 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11960 the ACLs :
11961
11962 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11963 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11964 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11965 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11966 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11967 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11968
11969 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011970 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11971 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011972
11973 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011974 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011975 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011976 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11977 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11978 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11979 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011980
11981 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11982
11983 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011984 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011985 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11986 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011987 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11988 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11989 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011990
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011991disable frontend <frontend>
11992 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11993 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11994 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11995 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11996 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11997 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11998 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11999 on the stats page.
12000
12001 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12002 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12003
12004 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12005 level "admin".
12006
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012007disable server <backend>/<server>
12008 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12009 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12010 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12011 during the maintenance.
12012
12013 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12014 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12015
12016 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012017 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012018
12019 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12020 level "admin".
12021
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012022enable frontend <frontend>
12023 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12024 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12025 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12026 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12027 which was disabled.
12028
12029 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12030 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12031
12032 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12033 level "admin".
12034
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012035enable server <backend>/<server>
12036 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12037 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12038
12039 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012040 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012041
12042 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12043 level "admin".
12044
12045get weight <backend>/<server>
12046 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12047 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12048 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12049 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12050 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012051 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012052
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012053help
12054 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12055 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012056
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012057prompt
12058 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12059 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12060 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12061 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12062 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12063 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12064 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12065 command.
12066
12067quit
12068 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012069
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012070set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012071 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12072 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12073 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12074 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12075 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012076 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12077 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12078
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012079set maxconn global <maxconn>
12080 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12081 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12082 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12083 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12084 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12085 setting.
12086
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012087set rate-limit connections global <value>
12088 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12089 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12090 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12091 is passed in number of connections per second.
12092
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012093set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12094 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12095 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012096 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12097 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012098
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012099set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012100 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12101 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12102 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12103 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012104 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12105 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012106
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012107set timeout cli <delay>
12108 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12109 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12110 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12111
12112set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
12113 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
12114 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090012115 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
12116 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
12117 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
12118 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
12119 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
12120 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
12121 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
12122 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
12123 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
12124 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
12125 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
12126 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
12127 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012128
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012129show errors [<iid>]
12130 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
12131 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012132 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
12133 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
12134 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012135
12136 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
12137 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
12138 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
12139 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
12140 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
12141 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
12142 are reported too.
12143
12144 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
12145 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
12146 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
12147 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
12148 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
12149 code.
12150
12151 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
12152 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
12153 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
12154 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
12155 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
12156 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
12157 line.
12158
12159 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012160 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12161 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012162 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
12163 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
12164
12165 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12166 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12167 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12168 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12169 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12170 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12171 00204+ minal\r\n
12172 00211 \r\n
12173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012174 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012175 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12176 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12177 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12178 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12179 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12180 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012181
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012182show info
12183 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12184
12185show sess
12186 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012187 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12188 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12189
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012190show sess <id>
12191 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12192 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12193 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12194 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12195 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012196 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12197 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12198 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012199
12200show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12201 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12202 possible to dump only selected items :
12203 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12204 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12205 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12206 for example:
12207 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12208 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12209 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12210
12211 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012212 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12213 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012214 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12215 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12216 Nbproc: 1
12217 Process_num: 1
12218 (...)
12219
12220 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12221 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12222 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12223 (...)
12224 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12225
12226 $
12227
12228 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12229 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12230 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12231 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012232 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012233
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012234show table
12235 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12236 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12237 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12238 entries currently in use.
12239
12240 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012241 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012242 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12243 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012244
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012245show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012246 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
12247 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
12248 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012249 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
12250
12251 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
12252 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
12253 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
12254 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
12255 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
12256
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012257 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12258 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12259 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12260 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12261 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12262 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12263
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012264
12265 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012266 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
12267 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012268
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012269 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012270 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012271 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012272 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12273 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12274 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12275 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012276
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012277 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012278 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012279 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12280 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012281
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012282 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
12283 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012284 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012285 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12286 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012287
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012288 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
12289 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012290 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012291 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12292 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
12293
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012294 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
12295 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
12296 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
12297 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
12298 time goes, the average event rate drops.
12299
12300 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
12301 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
12302 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012303 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
12304 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012305 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
12306 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020012307
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012308shutdown frontend <frontend>
12309 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
12310 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
12311 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
12312 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
12313 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
12314 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
12315 once it is terminated.
12316
12317 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12318 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12319
12320 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12321 level "admin".
12322
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020012323shutdown session <id>
12324 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
12325 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12326 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
12327 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
12328 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
12329 flag in the logs.
12330
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020012331shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
12332 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
12333 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
12334 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
12335 'K' flag in the logs.
12336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012337/*
12338 * Local variables:
12339 * fill-column: 79
12340 * End:
12341 */